WO2014078988A1 - 组调度授权的方法、用户设备和无线网络控制器 - Google Patents

组调度授权的方法、用户设备和无线网络控制器 Download PDF

Info

Publication number
WO2014078988A1
WO2014078988A1 PCT/CN2012/084894 CN2012084894W WO2014078988A1 WO 2014078988 A1 WO2014078988 A1 WO 2014078988A1 CN 2012084894 W CN2012084894 W CN 2012084894W WO 2014078988 A1 WO2014078988 A1 WO 2014078988A1
Authority
WO
WIPO (PCT)
Prior art keywords
rnti
user equipment
authorization
absolute
absolute authorization
Prior art date
Application number
PCT/CN2012/084894
Other languages
English (en)
French (fr)
Inventor
邵家枫
马雪利
李秉肇
Original Assignee
华为技术有限公司
Priority date (The priority date is an assumption and is not a legal conclusion. Google has not performed a legal analysis and makes no representation as to the accuracy of the date listed.)
Filing date
Publication date
Application filed by 华为技术有限公司 filed Critical 华为技术有限公司
Priority to PCT/CN2012/084894 priority Critical patent/WO2014078988A1/zh
Priority to EP12888970.6A priority patent/EP2914045B1/en
Priority to CN201280002400.5A priority patent/CN104025688A/zh
Publication of WO2014078988A1 publication Critical patent/WO2014078988A1/zh
Priority to US14/717,263 priority patent/US9769845B2/en

Links

Classifications

    • HELECTRICITY
    • H04ELECTRIC COMMUNICATION TECHNIQUE
    • H04WWIRELESS COMMUNICATION NETWORKS
    • H04W72/00Local resource management
    • H04W72/12Wireless traffic scheduling
    • H04W72/121Wireless traffic scheduling for groups of terminals or users
    • HELECTRICITY
    • H04ELECTRIC COMMUNICATION TECHNIQUE
    • H04WWIRELESS COMMUNICATION NETWORKS
    • H04W72/00Local resource management
    • H04W72/20Control channels or signalling for resource management
    • H04W72/23Control channels or signalling for resource management in the downlink direction of a wireless link, i.e. towards a terminal
    • HELECTRICITY
    • H04ELECTRIC COMMUNICATION TECHNIQUE
    • H04LTRANSMISSION OF DIGITAL INFORMATION, e.g. TELEGRAPHIC COMMUNICATION
    • H04L1/00Arrangements for detecting or preventing errors in the information received
    • H04L1/12Arrangements for detecting or preventing errors in the information received by using return channel
    • H04L1/16Arrangements for detecting or preventing errors in the information received by using return channel in which the return channel carries supervisory signals, e.g. repetition request signals
    • H04L1/18Automatic repetition systems, e.g. Van Duuren systems
    • H04L1/1812Hybrid protocols; Hybrid automatic repeat request [HARQ]
    • HELECTRICITY
    • H04ELECTRIC COMMUNICATION TECHNIQUE
    • H04WWIRELESS COMMUNICATION NETWORKS
    • H04W88/00Devices specially adapted for wireless communication networks, e.g. terminals, base stations or access point devices
    • H04W88/02Terminal devices
    • HELECTRICITY
    • H04ELECTRIC COMMUNICATION TECHNIQUE
    • H04WWIRELESS COMMUNICATION NETWORKS
    • H04W88/00Devices specially adapted for wireless communication networks, e.g. terminals, base stations or access point devices
    • H04W88/12Access point controller devices

Definitions

  • the present invention relates to the field of communications technologies, and in particular, to a method for group scheduling authorization, a user equipment, and a radio network controller. Background technique
  • WCDMA Wideband Code Division Multiple Access
  • R99 the 99th version
  • R4 the 4th version
  • R11 the 11th version
  • HSUPA High Speed Uplink Packet Access
  • HQQ Hybrid Automatic Repeat Request
  • Node B base station
  • TTI Transmission Time Interval
  • Short frame transmission HSUPA enables the maximum uplink data throughput rate of a single cell to reach 5.76 Mbit/s, which greatly enhances the data service carrying capacity and spectrum utilization rate of the WCDMA uplink.
  • UMTS Universal Mobile Telecommunications System
  • the market penetration rate of smartphones is getting higher and higher, the amount of network data processing is rapidly increasing, and the problem of uplink interference is gradually emerging.
  • uplink interference mainly comes from mutual interference between users.
  • Simulation and theoretical analysis prove that TDM scheduling for uplink transmission has a great inhibitory effect on inter-user interference. Therefore, TDM scheduling will not only be applied to the CELL-FACH state in the future, but will also be extended to the CELL-DCH state.
  • the information bits carried by the Enhanced Dedicated Channel Absolute Grant Channel include a 5-bit absolute grant value and a 1-bit absolute grant range.
  • the absolute authorization (absolute grant: AG) is set as follows: User Equipment (hereinafter referred to as User Equipment; : UE)
  • the E-DCH control information ie, AG
  • SFN system frame number
  • E-DCH Dedicated Physical Data Channel E-DCH Dedicated Physical Data Channel
  • E-DCH Radio Network Temporary Identifier E-DCH Radio Network Temporary Identifier
  • E-RNTI E-DCH Radio Network Temporary Identifier
  • the primary E-RNTI Primary E-RNTI; hereinafter referred to as PE-RNTI
  • PE-RNTI Primary E-RNTI
  • SE-RNTI Secondary E-RNTI
  • Deactivation is also not available for activation of every HARQ (per HARQ) process.
  • the present invention provides a method for group scheduling and authorization, a user equipment, and a radio network controller, so as to improve the efficiency of using downlink code resources and avoid downlink throughput limitation.
  • a first aspect of the present invention provides a method for group scheduling authorization, including:
  • the user equipment reports the capability of the user equipment to support the uplink enhanced dedicated channel to the radio network controller
  • the user equipment intercepts the first channel by using the E-RNTI carried in the configuration message, and activates or deactivates the hybrid automatic repeat request HARQ process according to the absolute authorization received by the user equipment in the first channel.
  • the E-RNTI carried in the configuration message includes a first E-RNTI and a primary E-RNTI, where the group to which the user equipment belongs The group-assigned E-RNTI is the first E-RNTI.
  • the absolute authorization to activate or deactivate the hybrid automatic repeat request HARQ process received in a channel includes: if the absolute authorization identifier received by the user equipment in the first channel is the first E-RNTI, and The absolute authorization value of the absolute authorization is a deactivation command.
  • the absolute authorization range of the absolute authorization is the per-HARQ process and the configured 2 ms transmission time interval TTI, the user equipment deactivates the HARQ process number corresponding to the current TTI.
  • the user equipment deactivates all HARQ processes; or, when the absolute authorization range of the absolute authorization is all HARQ processes and the secondary E-RNTI is configured, the user equipment activates all HARQ processes and will serve Authorized to store a second set authorization value and effectiveness of the main license is set to false.
  • the performing the hybrid automatic retransmission request HARQ process according to the absolute authorization received by the user equipment in the first channel includes: If the identifier of the absolute authorization received by the user equipment in the first channel is the first E-RNTI, and the absolute authorization value of the absolute authorization is not a deactivation command, then the absolute authorization range of the absolute authorization For each HARQ process, the user equipment activates the HARQ process corresponding to the HARQ process number corresponding to the current TTI; or, when the absolute authorization range of the absolute authorization is all HARQ processes, the user equipment activates all HARQ processes.
  • the absolute authorization to activate or deactivate the hybrid automatic repeat request HARQ process received in a channel includes: if the absolute authorization identifier received by the user equipment in the first channel is the first E-RNTI, and The absolute authorization value of the absolute authorization is not the deactivation command, and the user equipment activates the HARQ process corresponding to the HARQ process number corresponding to the current TTI, and deactivates the HARQ process corresponding to the HARQ process number corresponding to the current TTI in all the HARQ processes.
  • the HARQ process outside.
  • the method further includes: if the user equipment The identifier of the absolute authorization received in the first channel is the first E-RNTI, and the absolute authorization value of the absolute authorization is not a deactivation command, and the user equipment sets the primary authorization validity to true;
  • the absolute authorization value of the absolute authorization is not a deactivation command
  • the absolute authorization is determined
  • the user equipment starts the timer when the device is in an untriggered state, or the user equipment resets the timer when the absolutely authorized timer is in a triggered state.
  • the method further includes: if the user equipment The identifier of the absolute authorization received in the first channel is the first RN-RNTL ⁇ the primary E-RNTI or the primary authorization validity is set to false, and the absolute authorization is absolutely If the authorization value is not a deactivation command, when the absolute authorization value of the absolute authorization is not a zero authorization command, the user equipment sets the service authorization to a maximum value of the absolute authorization value and the minimum configuration service authorization value; or When the absolute authorization value of the absolute authorization is zero, the user equipment sets the service authorization to zero authorization.
  • the user equipment is controlled by the wireless network
  • the capability of the user equipment to support the uplink enhanced dedicated channel includes: the user equipment reporting to the radio network controller that the user equipment supports receiving an absolute authorization of the first E-RNTI during uplink enhanced dedicated channel operation Ability.
  • the E-RNTI carried in the configuration message includes a primary E-RNTI and a secondary E-RNTI, where the user equipment belongs to the group
  • the assigned E-RNTI is the secondary E-RNTI.
  • the determining, by the user equipment, the absolute authorization received or deactivated in the first channel includes: if the absolute authorization identifier received by the user equipment in the first channel is a secondary E-RNTI, and the absolute authorization value of the absolute authorization is a deactivation command, then The absolute authorization range of the absolute authorization is the HARQ process corresponding to the HARQ process number corresponding to the current TTI when the absolute authorization range is the per-HARQ process and the configured 2 millisecond TTI; or, when the absolute authorization range of the absolute authorization is The user equipment deactivates all HARQ processes for all HARQ processes and when a 2 millisecond TTI has been configured.
  • the performing, according to the absolute authorization received by the user equipment in the first channel, is activated or deactivated Activating the hybrid automatic repeat request HARQ process includes: if the identifier of the absolute authorization received by the user equipment in the first channel is a secondary E-RNTI, and the absolute authorized value of the absolute grant is not a deactivation command, When the absolute authorization range of the absolute authorization is the per-HARQ process, the user equipment activates the HARQ process corresponding to the HARQ process ID corresponding to the current TTI; or, when the absolute authorization range of the absolute authorization is all HARQ processes, The user equipment activates all HARQ processes.
  • the performing, by the user equipment, the absolute authorization to activate or deactivate the hybrid automatic repeat request HARQ process according to the first channel includes: if the user equipment receives in the first channel The identifier of the absolute authorization is the secondary E-RNTI, and the absolute authorization value of the absolute authorization is not the deactivation command, and the user equipment activates the HARQ process corresponding to the HARQ process number corresponding to the current TTI, and deactivates all HARQs.
  • the method further includes: if the user equipment is in the first channel The identifier of the received absolute authorization is a secondary E-RNTI, and the absolute authorization value of the absolute authorization is not a deactivation command, and when the absolute authorization value is not a zero authorization command, the user equipment sets the service authorization as a Determining a maximum value of the absolute authorization value and the minimum configuration service authorization value; or, when the absolute authorization value is a zero authorization command, the user equipment will serve Authorization is set to zero authorization.
  • the method further includes: if the user equipment receives an absolute in the first channel
  • the identifier of the authorization is a secondary E-RNTI, and the absolute authorization value of the absolute authorization is not a deactivation command, and the user equipment starts the timer when the absolute authorized timer is in an untriggered state; or The user equipment resets the timer when the absolutely authorized timer is in a triggered state.
  • the E-RNTI carried in the configuration message includes a primary E-RNTI; or the E-RNTI carried in the configuration message includes a primary E- RNTI and secondary E-RNTI.
  • the method Before deactivating the hybrid automatic repeat request HARQ process, the method further includes: when the user equipment receives an absolute authorization that is identified as a primary E-RNTI in the first channel, the user equipment determines that the identifier is a primary E-RNTI The type of absolute authorization is the primary authorization.
  • Absolute authorization activation or deactivation hybrid automatic received in the first channel Retransmitting the requesting HARQ process includes: if the absolute authorization identifier received by the user equipment in the first channel is a primary E-RNTI, and the absolute authorization value of the absolute authorization is a deactivation command, then The absolute authorization range of the absolute authorization is the HARQ process corresponding to the HARQ process number corresponding to the current TTI when the absolute authorization range is the per-HARQ process and the configured T2 TTI is configured; or, when the absolute authorization scope of the absolute authorization is all
  • the user equipment deactivates all HARQ processes when the HARQ process is configured with a 2 ms TTI and the secondary E-RNTI is not configured; or when the absolute authorization range of the absolute authorization is all HARQ processes and the configured secondary E-RNTI
  • the user equipment activates all HARQ processes, sets the service authorization to
  • the absolute authorization to activate or deactivate the hybrid automatic repeat request HARQ process in the first channel includes: if the absolute authorization identifier received by the user equipment in the first channel is a primary E-RNTI, and The absolute authorization value of the absolute authorization is not a deactivation command, and when the absolute authorization range of the absolute authorization is a per-HARQ process, the user equipment deactivates the HARQ process corresponding to the HARQ process number corresponding to the current TTI; or When the absolute authorization range of the absolute grant is all HARQ processes, the user equipment activates all HARQ processes.
  • the method further includes:
  • the identifier of the absolute authorization received by the user equipment in the first channel is the primary E-RNTI, and the absolute authorization value of the absolute authorization is not a deactivation command, and the user equipment sets the primary authorization validity to be true.
  • the method further includes: If the absolute authorization identifier received by the user equipment in the first channel is the primary E-RNTI, and the absolute authorization value of the absolute authorization is not a deactivation command, when the absolute authorized timer is in an untriggered state The user equipment starts the timer, or when the absolute authorized timer is in a trigger state, the user equipment resets the timer.
  • the method further includes: And the absolute authorization identifier received by the user equipment in the first channel is a primary E-RNTI or the primary authorization validity is set to false, and the absolute authorization value of the absolute authorization is not a deactivation command, When the absolute authorization value of the absolute authorization is not a zero authorization command, the user equipment sets the service authorization to the maximum value of the absolute authorization value and the minimum configuration service authorization value; or, when the absolute authorization value of the absolute authorization is zero When the command is authorized, the user equipment sets the service authorization to zero authorization.
  • the first channel includes an enhanced dedicated channel absolute grant channel E-AGCH, a public E-AGCH, or a non-serving cell E-AGCH.
  • a second aspect of the present invention provides a method for group scheduling authorization, including:
  • the base station After receiving the uplink enhanced dedicated channel configuration information of the user equipment sent by the radio network controller, the base station configures an enhanced dedicated channel radio network temporary identifier E-RNTI for the user equipment;
  • the base station sends an absolute grant identified by the configured E-RNTI to the user equipment by using the first channel.
  • the configuring, by the user equipment, the enhanced dedicated channel radio network temporary identifier E-RNTI includes: the base station configuring the user equipment first The E-RNTI and the primary E-RNTI; the E-RNTI allocated by the base station to the group to which the user equipment belongs is the first E-RNTI.
  • the base station sends an absolute authorization that is configured as a configured E-RNTI to the user equipment by using the first channel.
  • the method includes: if the current control requirement is separately controlled, sending, by the base station, an absolute authorization that is identified as the primary E-RNTI to the user equipment by using a first channel; or, if the current control requirement is group control, The base station sends the user equipment to the user equipment through the first channel
  • the transmission identifier is an absolute authorization of the first E-RNTI.
  • the base station sends the user to the user by using a first channel
  • the method further includes: if the base station needs to change the first E-RNTI of the user equipment, the base station sends the updated number to the radio network controller.
  • An E-RNTI and notifying the radio network controller to perform a change of the first E-RNTI, so that the radio network controller sends the updated first E-RNTI to the user equipment.
  • the configuring, by the user equipment, the enhanced dedicated channel radio network temporary identifier E-RNTI includes: the base station configuring a primary E for the user equipment An RNTI and a secondary E-RNTI; the E-RNTI allocated by the base station to the group to which the user equipment belongs is the secondary E-RNTI.
  • the base station sends an absolute authorization that is configured as a configured E-RNTI to the user equipment by using the first channel.
  • the method includes: if the current control requirement is separately controlled, sending, by the base station, an absolute authorization that is identified as the primary E-RNTI to the user equipment by using a first channel; or, if the current control requirement is group control, The base station sends an absolute grant identified by the user equipment to the secondary E-RNTI through the first channel.
  • the method further includes: if the base station needs to change the secondary E-RNTI of the user equipment, the base station sends the updated secondary E to the wireless network controller. - RNTI, and notifying the radio network controller to perform a change of the secondary E-RNTI, so that the radio network controller sends the updated secondary E-RNTI to the user equipment.
  • the configuring, by the user equipment, the enhanced dedicated channel radio network temporary identifier E-RNTI includes: the base station configuring a primary E for the user equipment - RNTI; or, the base station configures a primary E-RNTI and a secondary E-RNTL for the user equipment
  • the method further includes: sending, by the base station, HARQ process information allocated to the user equipment to the radio network controller.
  • the base station sends the HARQ process information that is allocated to the user equipment to the radio network controller And the base station sends the process status information of the user equipment to the radio network controller, so that the radio network controller initially configures or reconfigures the process status of the user equipment according to the process status information.
  • the method further includes: sending, by the base station, process status information of the user equipment to the radio network controller.
  • the process state information includes the user equipment
  • the hybrid automatic repeat request HARQ process activates or deactivates one or a combination of status information, HARQ process load information, high and low speed indication messages, and indication authorization messages.
  • the base station After the base station receives the uplink enhanced dedicated channel configuration information of the user equipment sent by the radio network controller, before the configuring the enhanced dedicated channel radio network temporary identifier E-RNTI for the user equipment, the base station further includes: the base station receiving station An indication message sent by the radio network controller, where the indication message is used to indicate that the base station performs message configuration for radio link establishment.
  • the configuring the enhanced dedicated channel radio network temporary identifier E-RNTI for the user equipment includes: the base station configuring an E-RNTI for the user equipment according to the current control reference information; the current control reference information includes: the user equipment Rate, the user setting The data block, the process number assigned by the user equipment, the grouping information corresponding to the user equipment, and one or a combination of current cell process usage conditions.
  • the absolute authorization includes an activation or deactivation indication of the HARQ process of the user equipment, and the activation indication of the HARQ process of the user equipment is a specific authorization value.
  • a third aspect of the present invention provides a method for group scheduling authorization, including:
  • the radio network controller receives an E-RNTI configured by the base station for the user equipment, and sends an E-RNTI configured by the base station to the user equipment to the user equipment, so as to
  • the user equipment listens to the first channel with the configured E-RNTI, and activates or deactivates the hybrid automatic repeat request HARQ process according to the absolute grant received in the first channel.
  • the E-RNTI configured by the base station for the user equipment includes a first E-RNTI and a primary E-RNTI;
  • the E-RNTI allocated by the group to which the user equipment belongs is the first E-RNTI.
  • the method further includes: the radio network controller receiving the updated first E-RNTI sent by the base station, and receiving a notification sent by the base station to perform a change of the first E-RNTI; the radio network controller The updated first E-RNTI is sent to the user equipment.
  • the E-RNTI configured by the base station for the user equipment includes a primary E-RNTI and a secondary E-RNTI, where the base station is the user
  • the E-RNTI allocated by the group to which the device belongs is the secondary E-RNTI.
  • the E-RNTI configured by the base station for the user equipment includes a primary E-RNTI; or the base station is configured by the user equipment.
  • E-RNTI includes primary E-RNTI and secondary E-RNTL
  • the method further includes: the radio network controller receiving the HARQ process information allocated by the base station to the user equipment.
  • the method includes: the radio network controller receiving process state information of the user equipment sent by the base station; and the radio network controller initially configuring or reconfiguring process state information of the user equipment according to the process state information.
  • the method further includes: receiving, by the radio network controller, process status information of the user equipment sent by the base station.
  • the radio network controller After the radio network controller sends the uplink enhanced dedicated channel configuration information of the user equipment to the base station, before receiving, by the radio network controller, the E-RNTI configured by the base station for the user equipment, the radio network controller further includes The radio network controller sends an indication message to the base station, where the indication message is used to indicate that the base station performs message configuration for radio link establishment.
  • a fourth aspect of the present invention provides a user equipment, including:
  • An reporting module configured to report, to the radio network controller, the capability of the user equipment to support an uplink enhanced dedicated channel
  • a receiving module configured to receive a configuration message sent by the radio network controller, where the configuration The message carries an enhanced dedicated channel radio network temporary identifier E-RNTI;
  • a monitoring module configured to: monitor, by the E-RNTI, the first channel carried by the configuration message received by the receiving module;
  • an activation/deactivation module configured to activate or deactivate the hybrid automatic repeat request HARQ process according to the absolute authorization received by the listening module in the first channel.
  • the E-RNTI carried in the configuration message received by the receiving module includes an E-RNTI and a primary E-RNTI;
  • the E-RNTI allocated by the group to which the device belongs is the first E-RNTI.
  • the user equipment further includes: a first determining module
  • the first determining module is configured to: when the activation/deactivation module activates or deactivates the HARQ process, when the listening module receives the identifier as the first E-RNTI or the primary E- in the first channel When the RNTI is absolutely authorized, it is determined that the type of the absolute authorization identified as the first E-RNTI or the primary E-RNTI is the primary authorization.
  • the activation/deactivation module is specifically used to When the identifier of the absolute authorization received by the listening module in the first channel is the first E-RNTI, and the absolute authorization value of the absolute authorization is a deactivation command, if the absolute authorization scope of the absolute authorization is Deactivating the HARQ process corresponding to the HARQ process number corresponding to the current TTI for each HARQ process and the configured 2 ms transmission time interval TTI; or, if the absolute authorization range of the absolute authorization is all HARQ processes, 2 ms have been configured If the TTI is not configured with the secondary E-RNTI, all HARQ processes are deactivated; or, if the absolute authorization range of the absolute grant is all HARQ processes and the configured secondary E-RNTI, all HARQ processes are activated, and the service authorization is set to Store the second authorization value and set the primary authorization validity to false.
  • the activation/deactivation module is specifically configured to be used When the identifier of the absolute authorization received by the listening module in the first channel is the first E-RNTI, and the absolute authorization value of the absolute authorization is not a deactivation command, if the absolute authorization scope of the absolute authorization For each HARQ process, activate the current TTI The HARQ process corresponding to the HARQ process number; or, if the absolute authorization range of the absolute authorization is all HARQ processes, all HARQ processes are activated.
  • the activation/deactivation module is specifically used to When the identifier of the absolute authorization received by the monitoring module in the first channel is the first E-RNTI, and the absolute authorization value of the absolute authorization is not the deactivation command, the HARQ process number corresponding to the current TTI is activated. Corresponding HARQ process, and deactivate the HARQ process except the HARQ process corresponding to the HARQ process number corresponding to the current TTI in all HARQ processes.
  • the user equipment further includes: a first setting module ;
  • the first setting module is configured to: when the identifier of the absolute authorization received by the listening module in the first channel is the first E-RNTI, and the absolute authorization value of the absolute authorization is not a deactivation command, Set the master authorization validity to true;
  • the first setting module is configured to: when the identifier of the absolute authorization received by the listening module in the first channel is the first E-RNTI, and the absolute authorization value of the absolute authorization is not a deactivation command, The timer is started if the absolutely authorized timer is in an untriggered state, or is reset if the absolutely authorized timer is in a triggered state
  • the first setting module is configured to: when the monitoring module receives an absolute authorization identifier in the first channel, the first E-RNTI, the primary E-RNTI, or the primary authorization validity is set to false, and When the absolute authorization value of the absolute authorization is not the deactivation command, if the absolute authorization value of the absolute authorization is not the zero authorization command, the service authorization is set to the maximum value of the absolute authorization value and the minimum configuration service authorization value; or If the absolute authorization value of the absolute authorization is zero authorization command, the service authorization is set to zero authorization.
  • the reporting module is specifically configured to report, to the radio network controller, the capability of the user equipment to support receiving an absolute authorization of the first E-RNTI during uplink enhanced dedicated channel operation.
  • the E-RNTI carried in the configuration message received by the receiving module includes a primary E-RNTI and a secondary E-RNTI, where the user equipment is The E-RNTI allocated by the associated group is the secondary E-RNTI.
  • the activation/deactivation module is specifically configured to: when the monitoring module is in the first channel The identifier of the received absolute authorization is the secondary E-RNTI, and when the absolute authorization value of the absolute authorization is the deactivation command, if the absolute authorization range of the absolute authorization is per HARQ process and the configured 2 millisecond TTI, then go The HARQ process corresponding to the HARQ process ID corresponding to the current TTI is activated. Alternatively, if the absolute authorization range of the absolute authorization is all HARQ processes and the configured 2 millisecond TTI is configured, all HARQ processes are deactivated.
  • the activation/deactivation module is specifically configured to: when the monitoring module is in the first channel
  • the identifier of the received absolute authorization is the secondary E-RNTI, and the absolute authorization value of the absolute authorization is not the deactivation command. If the absolute authorization range of the absolute authorization is per HARQ process, the HARQ process corresponding to the current TTI is activated. The HARQ process corresponding to the number; or, if the absolute authorization range of the absolute authorization is all HARQ processes, all HARQ processes are activated.
  • the activation/deactivation module is specifically configured to: when the monitoring module is in the first channel
  • the identifier of the absolute authorization received is the secondary E-RNTI, and the absolute authorization value of the absolute authorization is not the deactivation command, the HARQ process corresponding to the HARQ process number corresponding to the current TTI is activated, and all HARQ processes are deactivated.
  • the user equipment further includes: a second setting module
  • the second setting module is configured to: when the identifier of the absolute authorization received by the listening module in the first channel is a secondary E-RNTI, and the absolute authorization value of the absolute authorization is not a deactivation command, if If the absolute authorization value is not a zero authorization command, the service authorization is set to Determining the maximum value of the absolute authorization value and the minimum configuration service authorization value; or, if the absolute authorization value is a zero authorization command, setting the service authorization to zero authorization;
  • the second setting module is configured to: when the identifier of the absolute authorization received by the listening module in the first channel is a secondary E-RNTI, and the absolute authorization value of the absolute authorization is not a deactivation command, if The timer is started when the absolute authorized timer is in an untriggered state; or, if the absolutely authorized timer is in a triggered state, the timer is reset.
  • the E-RNTI carried in the configuration message received by the receiving module includes a primary E-RNTI; or the configuration message received by the receiving module carries The E-RNTI includes a primary E-RNTI and a secondary E-RNTI;
  • the user equipment further includes: a second determining module
  • the activating/deactivating module Specifically, when the identifier of the absolute authorization received by the monitoring module in the first channel is a primary E-RNTI, and the absolute authorization value of the absolute authorization is a deactivation command, if the absolute authorization is absolute The authorization range is the per-HARQ process and the configured 2 ms, then the HARQ process corresponding to the HARQ process number corresponding to the current TTI is deactivated. Alternatively, if the absolute authorization range of the absolute authorization is all HARQ processes, 2 ms has been configured.
  • all the HARQ processes are deactivated if the secondary E-RNTI is not configured; or, if the absolute authorization range of the absolute authorization is all HARQ processes and the configured secondary E-RNTI, all HARQ processes are activated, and the service authorization is set to be stored. The second authorization value, and the primary authorization validity is set to false.
  • the activating/deactivating module Specifically, when the identifier of the absolute authorization received by the monitoring module in the first channel is a primary E-RNTI, and the absolute authorization value of the absolute authorization is not a deactivation command. If the absolute authorization range of the absolute authorization is the per-HARQ process, the HARQ process corresponding to the HARQ process number corresponding to the current TTI is deactivated; or, if the absolute authorization range of the absolute authorization is all HARQ processes, the activation is performed. All HARQ processes.
  • the user equipment further includes: Three setting modules;
  • the third setting module is configured to: when the identifier of the absolute authorization received by the listening module in the first channel is a primary E-RNTI, and the absolute authorized value of the absolute authorization is not a deactivation command, Master authorization validity is set to true;
  • the third setting module is configured to: when the identifier of the absolute authorization received by the listening module in the first channel is a primary E-RNTI, and the absolute authorized value of the absolute authorization is not a deactivation command, if The timer is started when the absolute authorized timer is in an untriggered state, or is reset if the absolutely authorized timer is in a triggered state; or
  • the third setting module is configured to: when the monitoring module receives the absolute authorization identifier in the first channel as the primary E-RNTI or the primary authorization validity is set to false, and the absolute authorization of the absolute authorization
  • the service authorization is set to a maximum value of the absolute authorization value and the minimum configuration service authorization value; or, if the absolute authorization is performed
  • the absolute authorization value is zero for the authorization command, and the service authorization is set to zero authorization.
  • a fifth aspect of the present invention provides a base station, including:
  • a receiving module configured to receive uplink enhanced dedicated channel configuration information of the user equipment sent by the radio network controller
  • a configuration module configured to: after the receiving module receives the uplink enhanced dedicated channel configuration information of the user equipment, configure an enhanced dedicated channel wireless network temporary identifier E-RNTI for the user equipment;
  • a sending module configured to send the E-RNTI configured by the configuration module to the user equipment to the radio network controller, and send an absolute authorization that is configured as the configured E-RNTI to the user equipment by using the first channel.
  • the configuration module is configured to configure a first E-RNTI and a primary E-RNTI for the user equipment, where the configuration module is The E-RNTI allocated by the group to which the user equipment belongs is the first E-RNTI.
  • the sending module is configured to send, by using the first channel, the configured E-RNTI to the user equipment Absolute authorizations include:
  • the sending module is specifically configured to: when the current control requirement is a separate control, send, by using the first channel, an absolute authorization that is identified as the primary E-RNTI to the user equipment; or, when the current control requirement is a group control And transmitting an absolute authorization identified by the first E-RNTI to the user equipment by using a first channel.
  • the configuration module is configured to configure a primary E-RNTI and a secondary E-RNTI for the user equipment, where the configuration module is The E-RNTI allocated by the group to which the user equipment belongs is the secondary E-RNTI.
  • the sending module is configured to send, by using the first channel, an E-RNTI that is configured as a configuration to the user equipment
  • the absolute authorization includes: the sending module is configured to: when the current control requirement is separately controlled, send, by using the first channel, an absolute authorization that is identified as the primary E-RNTI to the user equipment; or, in a current control requirement When the group is controlled, an absolute authorization identified as the secondary E-RNTI is sent to the user equipment through the first channel.
  • the sending module is further used in After the user equipment sends the absolute E-RNTI identified as the configured E-RNTI, when the base station needs to change the secondary E-RNTI of the user equipment, send the radio network controller to the radio network controller. Sending the updated secondary E-RNTI, and notifying the radio network controller to perform a change of the secondary E-RNTI, so that the radio network controller sends the updated secondary E-RNTI to the user equipment.
  • the configuration module is specifically configured to: configure a primary E-RNTI for the user equipment; or configure a primary E-RNTI for the user equipment And auxiliary E-RNTL
  • the sending module is further configured to: after the configuring module configures an E-RNTI for the user equipment And transmitting, by the configuration module, HARQ process information allocated by the user equipment to the radio network controller.
  • the sending module is further configured to: use the configuration module to allocate the HARQ process to the user equipment After the information is sent to the radio network controller, the process status information of the user equipment is sent to the radio network controller, so that the radio network controller initially configures or reconfigures the user according to the process status information.
  • the process state of the device is further configured to: use the configuration module to allocate the HARQ process to the user equipment.
  • the sending module And sending, to the radio network controller, process state information of the user equipment, after sending the absolute authorization that is configured as the configured E-RNTI to the user equipment.
  • the receiving module is further configured to: after receiving the uplink enhanced dedicated channel configuration information of the user equipment that is sent by the radio network controller, the configuration module configures the enhanced dedicated channel radio network temporary identifier E- Before the RNTI, the indication message sent by the radio network controller is received, where the indication message is used to indicate that the base station performs message configuration for radio link establishment.
  • the configuration module is specifically configured to configure an E-RNTI for the user equipment according to the current control reference information;
  • the current control reference information includes: the user equipment One or a combination of a rate, a data block of the user equipment, a process number to which the user equipment is assigned, packet information corresponding to the user equipment, and current cell process usage.
  • a sixth aspect of the present invention provides a radio network controller, including:
  • a receiving module configured to receive, by the user equipment, the capability of the user equipment to support an uplink enhanced dedicated channel; and after the sending module sends the uplink enhanced dedicated channel configuration information of the user equipment to the base station, receive the Decoding an E-RNTI configured by the base station for the user equipment;
  • the sending module is configured to send the uplink enhanced dedicated channel configuration information of the user equipment to the base station; and after the receiving module receives the E-RNTI configured by the base station and configured by the base station as the user equipment, Transmitting, by the base station, the E-RNTI configured by the user equipment to the user equipment, so that the user equipment monitors the first channel by using the configured E-RNTI, and receives according to the first channel
  • the absolute authorization to activate or deactivate the hybrid automatic repeat request HARQ process is configured to send the uplink enhanced dedicated channel configuration information of the user equipment to the base station.
  • the E-RNTI that is configured by the receiving module and configured by the base station to the user equipment includes a first E-RNTI and a primary E-RNTI;
  • the E-RNTI allocated by the base station to the group to which the user equipment belongs is the first E-RNTI.
  • the receiving module is further configured to configure, by the sending module, the base station as the user equipment After the E-RNTI is sent to the user equipment, receiving the updated first E-RNTI sent by the base station, and receiving a notification that the base station sends a change to the first E-RNTI; the sending module, And is further configured to send the updated first E-RNTI received by the receiving module to the user equipment.
  • the E-RNTI configured by the receiving, by the receiving module, the user equipment includes a primary E-RNTI and a secondary E-RNTI;
  • the E-RNTI allocated by the base station to the group to which the user equipment belongs is the secondary E-RNTL
  • the receiving module is further configured to configure, by the sending module, the base station as the user equipment After the E-RNTI is sent to the user equipment, receiving the sent by the base station a new secondary E-RNTI, and a notification of receiving a change of the secondary E-RNTI sent by the base station; the sending module is further configured to send the updated secondary E-RNTI received by the receiving module to the User equipment.
  • the E-RNTI that is configured by the receiving, by the receiving, the user equipment is a primary E-RNTI, or the receiving module
  • the received E-RNTI configured by the base station for the user equipment includes a primary E-RNTI and a secondary E-RNTL
  • the receiving module is further configured to: in the sending module, the uplink enhanced dedicated channel of the user equipment After the configuration information is sent to the base station, the HARQ process information allocated by the base station to the user equipment is received.
  • the radio network controller further includes: a configuration module
  • the receiving module is further configured to: after receiving the HARQ process information that is allocated by the base station to the user equipment, receive process state information of the user equipment that is sent by the base station;
  • the configuration module is configured to initially configure or reconfigure a process state of the user equipment according to process state information received by the receiving module.
  • the receiving module And after receiving, by the sending module, the E-RNTI configured by the base station for the user equipment, to send the user equipment, the process status information of the user equipment sent by the base station.
  • the sending module is further configured to: after the uplink enhanced dedicated channel configuration information of the user equipment is sent to the base station, the receiving module receives, by the base station, the E- configured by the base station for the user equipment Before the RNTI, the indication message is sent to the base station, where the indication message is used to indicate that the base station performs message configuration for establishing a radio link.
  • a seventh aspect of the present invention provides a user equipment, including:
  • a transmitter configured to report the user equipment to the radio network controller to support uplink enhancement Channel capability
  • a receiver configured to receive a configuration message sent by the radio network controller, where the configuration message carries an enhanced dedicated channel radio network temporary identifier E-RNTI;
  • a processor configured to: listen to the first channel by using an E-RNTI carried by the configuration message received by the receiver, and activate or deactivate the hybrid automatic repeat request HARQ process according to the absolute authorization received in the first channel .
  • the E-RNTI carried by the configuration message received by the receiver includes an E-RNTI and a primary E-RNTI;
  • the E-RNTI allocated by the group to which the device belongs is the first E-RNTI.
  • the processor is further configured to: before the activating or deactivating the HARQ process, When an absolute grant identified as the first E-RNTI or the primary E-RNTI is received in the channel, the type of the absolute grant identified as the E-RNTI or the primary E-RNTI is determined to be the primary grant.
  • the absolute authorization to activate or deactivate the hybrid automatic repeat request HARQ process received in the channel includes:
  • the processor is specifically configured to: when the identifier of the absolute authorization received in the first channel is the first E-RNTI, and the absolute authorization value of the absolute authorization is a deactivation command, if the absolute authorization If the absolute authorization range is the per-HARQ process and the configured 2 ms transmission time interval TTI, the HARQ process corresponding to the HARQ process number corresponding to the current TTI is deactivated; or, if the absolute authorization range of the absolute authorization is all HARQ processes, If the 2 ms TTI is configured and the secondary E-RNTI is not configured, all HARQ processes are deactivated; or if the absolute authorization range of the absolute authorization is all HARQ processes and the secondary E-RNTI is configured, all HARQ processes are activated,
  • the service authorization is set to store the second authorization value and set the primary authorization validity to false.
  • the absolute authorization to activate or deactivate the hybrid automatic repeat request HARQ process received in the channel includes: The processor is specifically configured to: when the identifier of the absolute authorization received in the first channel is the first E-RNTI, and the absolute authorization value of the absolute authorization is not a deactivation command, if the absolute authorization
  • the absolute authorization range is the HARQ process corresponding to the HARQ process number corresponding to the current TTI for each HARQ process; or, if the absolute authorization range of the absolute authorization is all HARQ processes, all HARQ processes are activated.
  • the processor is specifically configured to: when the identifier of the absolute authorization received in the first channel is the first E-RNTI, and the absolute authorization value of the absolute authorization is not a deactivation command, activate the current TTI The HARQ process corresponding to the HARQ process ID, and deactivates the HARQ process except the HARQ process corresponding to the HARQ process number corresponding to the current TTI in all the HARQ processes.
  • the processor is further used to
  • the identifier of the absolute authorization received in the first channel is the first E-RNTI, and the absolute authorization value of the absolute authorization is not the deactivation command, and the primary authorization validity is set to true; or
  • the processor is further configured to: when the identifier of the absolute authorization received in the first channel is the first E-RNTI, and the absolute authorization value of the absolute authorization is not a deactivation command, if the absolute authorization The timer is started in an untriggered state, or the timer is reset if the absolutely authorized timer is in a triggered state.
  • the processor is further used to When the identifier of the absolute authorization received in the first channel is the first E-RNTI, the primary E-RNTI, or the primary authorization validity is set to false, and the absolute authorized value of the absolute authorization is not a deactivation command, if If the absolute authorization value of the absolute authorization is not a zero authorization command, the service authorization is set to the maximum value of the absolute authorization value and the minimum configuration service authorization value; or, if the absolute authorization value of the absolute authorization is zero authorization command, Set the service authorization to Zero authorization.
  • the E-RNTI carried by the configuration message received by the receiver includes a primary E-RNTI and a secondary E-RNTI, where the user equipment is The E-RNTI allocated by the associated group is the secondary E-RNTI.
  • the processor is configured to activate or deactivate the hybrid according to the absolute authorization received in the first channel
  • the automatic retransmission request HARQ process includes:
  • the processor is specifically configured to: when the identifier of the absolute authorization received in the first channel is a secondary E-RNTI, and the absolute authorization value of the absolute authorization is a deactivation command, if the absolute authorization is The absolute authorization range is the HARQ process corresponding to the HARQ process number corresponding to the current TTI, and the absolute authorization range of the absolute authorization is all HARQ processes and configured for 2 milliseconds. TTI, then deactivate all HARQ processes.
  • the processor is configured to activate or deactivate according to an absolute authorization received in the first channel
  • the hybrid automatic repeat request HARQ process includes:
  • the processor is specifically configured to: when the identifier of the absolute authorization received in the first channel is a secondary E-RNTI, and the absolute authorization value of the absolute authorization is not a deactivation command, if the absolute authorization is The absolute authorization range is the HARQ process corresponding to the HARQ process number corresponding to the current TTI for each HARQ process; or, if the absolute authorization range of the absolute authorization is all HARQ processes, all HARQ processes are activated.
  • the processor is configured to activate or deactivate according to an absolute authorization received in the first channel
  • the hybrid automatic repeat request HARQ process includes:
  • the processor is specifically configured to: when the identifier of the absolute authorization received in the first channel is a secondary E-RNTI, and the absolute authorization value of the absolute authorization is not a deactivation command, The HARQ process corresponding to the current HARQ process number corresponding to the TTI, and deactivate all HARQ processes.
  • the processor is further configured to: when the absolute authorization is received in the first channel The identifier is a secondary E-RNTI, and when the absolute authorization value of the absolute authorization is not a deactivation command, if the absolute authorization value is not a zero authorization command, the service authorization is set to the absolute authorization value and the minimum configuration service authorization value. The maximum value; or, if the absolute authorization value is a zero authorization command, the service authorization is set to zero authorization.
  • the processor is further configured to: when the absolute authorization is received in the first channel
  • the identifier is a secondary E-RNTI, and when the absolute authorization value of the absolute authorization is not a deactivation command, if the absolute authorized timer is in an untriggered state, the timer is started; or, if the absolute authorization is When the timer is in the trigger state, the timer is reset.
  • the E-RNTI carried by the configuration message received by the receiver includes a primary E-RNTI; or the configuration message received by the receiver carries The E-RNTI includes a primary E-RNTI and a secondary E-RNTI.
  • the absolute authorization to activate or deactivate the hybrid automatic repeat request HARQ process received in the first channel includes:
  • the processor is specifically configured to: when the identifier of the absolute authorization received in the first channel is a primary E-RNTI, and the absolute authorization value of the absolute authorization is a deactivation command, if the absolute authorization is If the absolute authorization range is the per-HARQ process and the configured T-second TTI, the HARQ process corresponding to the HARQ process number corresponding to the current TTI is deactivated; or if the absolute authorization range of the absolute authorization is all HARQ processes, 2 ms has been configured. TTI and no If the secondary E-RNTI is configured, all the HARQ processes are deactivated. Alternatively, if the absolute authorization range of the absolute authorization is all HARQ processes and the configured secondary E-RNTI, all HARQ processes are activated, and the service authorization is set to store the second. Authorize the value and set the primary authorization validity to false.
  • the processor is used according to The absolute authorization to activate or deactivate the hybrid automatic repeat request HARQ process received in the first channel includes:
  • the processor is specifically configured to: when the identifier of the absolute authorization received in the first channel is a primary E-RNTI, and the absolute authorization value of the absolute authorization is not a deactivation command, if the absolute authorization is If the absolute authorization range is the per-HARQ process, the HARQ process corresponding to the HARQ process number corresponding to the current TTI is deactivated. Alternatively, if the absolute authorization range of the absolute authorization is all HARQ processes, all HARQ processes are activated.
  • the processor is further configured to: when the identifier of the absolute authorization received in the first channel is the primary E-RNTI, and the absolute authorization value of the absolute authorization is not a deactivation command, set the primary authorization validity Be true
  • the processor is further configured to: when the identifier of the absolute authorization received in the first channel is a primary E-RNTI, and the absolute authorization value of the absolute authorization is not a deactivation command, if the absolute authorization is The timer is started when the timer is in an untriggered state; or, if the absolutely authorized timer is in a triggered state, the timer is reset.
  • the processor is further configured to: when the identifier of the absolute authorization received in the first channel is the primary E-RNTI or the primary authorization validity is set to false, and the absolute authorization value of the absolute authorization is not a deactivation command And if the absolute authorization value of the absolute authorization is not a zero authorization command, setting the service authorization to a maximum value of the absolute authorization value and the minimum configuration service authorization value; or, if the absolute authorization value of the absolute authorization is The zero authorization command sets the service authorization to zero authorization.
  • An eighth aspect of the present invention provides a base station, including:
  • a receiver configured to receive uplink enhanced dedicated channel configuration information of the user equipment sent by the radio network controller
  • the transmitter is configured to send, by using the first channel, the configured E-RNTI to the user equipment Absolute authorization includes:
  • the transmitter is specifically configured to send an absolute authorization that is identified as the primary E-RNTI to the user equipment by using a first channel when the current control requirement is a separate control; or, when the current control requirement is group control And transmitting an absolute authorization identified by the first E-RNTI to the user equipment by using the first channel.
  • the transmitter is further used in After the user equipment sends the first E-RNTI that is identified as the configured E-RNTI, when the base station needs to change the first E-RNTI of the user equipment, send the updated first E-RNTI to the radio network controller. And notifying the radio network controller to perform the change of the first E-RNTI, so that the radio network controller sends the updated first E-RNTI to the user equipment.
  • the processor is configured to configure a primary E-RNTI and a secondary E-RNTI for the user equipment, where the processor is The E-RNTI allocated by the group to which the user equipment belongs is the secondary E-RNTI.
  • the sending, by the transmitter, the absolute authorization to send the E-RNTI that is configured as the configuration to the user equipment by using the first channel includes:
  • the transmitter is specifically configured to send an absolute authorization that is identified as the primary E-RNTI to the user equipment by using a first channel when the current control requirement is a separate control; or, when the current control requirement is group control And transmitting, by the first channel, an absolute authorization identified as the secondary E-RNTI to the user equipment.
  • the transmitter is further used in After the user equipment sends the absolute authorization of the configured E-RNTI, when the base station needs to change the secondary E-RNTI of the user equipment, send the updated secondary E-RNTI to the radio network controller, and Notifying the radio network controller to perform a change of the secondary E-RNTI, so that the radio network controller sends the updated secondary E-RNTI to the user equipment.
  • the processor is configured to configure a primary E-RNTI for the user equipment, or configure a primary E-RNTI for the user equipment.
  • auxiliary E-RNTL for the user equipment
  • the transmitter is further configured to: after the processor configures an E-RNTI for the user equipment And transmitting, by the processor, the HARQ process information allocated by the user equipment to the radio network controller.
  • the transmitter is further configured to: use the processor to allocate the HARQ process to the user equipment After the information is sent to the radio network controller, the process status information of the user equipment is sent to the radio network controller, so that the radio network controller initially configures or reconfigures the user according to the process status information.
  • the process state of the device is further configured to: use the processor to allocate the HARQ process to the user equipment After the information is sent to the radio network controller, the process status information of the user equipment is sent to the radio network controller, so that the radio network controller initially configures or reconfigures the user according to the process status information. The process state of the device.
  • the receiver is further configured to: after receiving the uplink enhanced dedicated channel configuration information of the user equipment that is sent by the radio network controller, the processor configures the enhanced dedicated channel radio network temporary identifier E- Before the RNTI, the indication message sent by the radio network controller is received, where the indication message is used to indicate that the base station performs message configuration for radio link establishment.
  • any one of the tenth possible implementation manners of the eighth aspect, the twelfth possible implementation of the eighth aspect In the way,
  • the current control reference information includes: a rate of the user equipment, a data block of the user equipment, a process number assigned by the user equipment, group information corresponding to the user equipment, and a current cell process. One or a combination of situations.
  • a ninth aspect of the present invention provides a radio network controller, including:
  • a receiver configured to receive, by the user equipment, the capability of the user equipment to support an uplink enhanced dedicated channel; and after the transmitter sends the uplink enhanced dedicated channel configuration information of the user equipment to the base station, receive the location sent by the base station Decoding an E-RNTI configured by the base station for the user equipment;
  • the transmitter is configured to send the uplink enhanced dedicated channel configuration information of the user equipment to the base station; and after the receiver receives the E-RNTI configured by the base station and configured by the base station as the user equipment, Transmitting, by the base station, the E-RNTI configured by the user equipment to the user equipment, so that the user equipment monitors the first channel by using the configured E-RNTI, and receives according to the first channel
  • the absolute authorization to activate or deactivate the hybrid automatic repeat request HARQ process is configured to send the uplink enhanced dedicated channel configuration information of the user equipment to the base station.
  • the E-RNTI that is configured by the receiver to be configured by the user equipment includes a first E-RNTI and a primary E-RNTI;
  • the E-RNTI allocated by the base station to the group to which the user equipment belongs is the first E-RNTI.
  • the receiver is further configured to: after the transmitter sends the E-RNTI configured by the base station to the user equipment to the user equipment, receive an updated first sent by the base station An E-RNTI, and receiving a notification that the base station sends a change of the first E-RNTI; the transmitter is further configured to send the updated first E-RNTI received by the receiver to the user device.
  • the E-RNTI configured by the receiver and configured by the receiver for the user equipment includes a primary E-RNTI and a secondary E-RNTI;
  • the E-RNTI allocated by the base station to the group to which the user equipment belongs is the secondary E-RNTL
  • the receiver is further configured to configure the base station as the user equipment in the transmitter After the E-RNTI is sent to the user equipment, receiving an updated secondary E-RNTI sent by the base station, and receiving a notification sent by the base station to perform a change of the secondary E-RNTI; And sending the updated secondary E-RNTI received by the receiver to the user equipment.
  • the E-RNTI configured by the receiver for the user equipment includes a primary E-RNTI; or the receiver The received E-RNTI configured by the base station for the user equipment includes a primary E-RNTI and a secondary E-RNTL
  • the receiver is further configured to: in the transmitter, the uplink enhanced dedicated channel of the user equipment After the configuration information is sent to the base station, the HARQ process information allocated by the base station to the user equipment is received.
  • the receiver is further configured to: after receiving the HARQ process information that is allocated by the base station to the user equipment, receive process state information of the user equipment sent by the base station;
  • the processor is configured to initially configure or reconfigure a process state of the user equipment according to process state information received by the receiver.
  • the receiver is further configured to configure, by the transmitter, the base station as the user equipment.
  • the process status information of the user equipment sent by the base station is received.
  • the ninth possible implementation manner of the ninth aspect The transmitter is further configured to: after the uplink enhanced dedicated channel configuration information of the user equipment is sent to the base station, the receiver receives the E- configured by the base station for the user equipment Before the RNTI, the indication message is sent to the base station, where the indication message is used to indicate that the base station performs message configuration for establishing a radio link.
  • the technical effect of the present invention is: the user equipment reports the capability of the user equipment to support the uplink enhanced dedicated channel to the radio network controller, and receives the configuration message sent by the radio network controller, and uses the E-RNTI interception carried in the configuration message.
  • the E-RNTI carried in the configuration message includes an E-RNTI allocated for the group to which the user equipment belongs, and then the user equipment activates or deactivates the HARQ process according to the absolute authorization received in the first channel. Therefore, the E-RNTI allocated for the group to which the user equipment belongs according to the foregoing configuration message can be used to control all user equipments in a group, thereby implementing the operation of the group activation or deactivation process, which is reduced.
  • the use of E-AGCH improves the efficiency of downlink code resources and avoids limited downlink throughput.
  • FIG. 1 is a flow chart of an embodiment of a method for group scheduling authorization according to the present invention
  • FIG. 2 is a flow chart of another embodiment of a method for group scheduling authorization according to the present invention.
  • FIG. 3 is a flow chart of still another embodiment of a method for group scheduling authorization according to the present invention.
  • FIG. 4 is a flow chart of still another embodiment of a method for group scheduling authorization according to the present invention
  • FIG. 5 is a flowchart of still another embodiment of a method for group scheduling authorization according to the present invention
  • FIG. 6 is a flowchart of still another embodiment of a method for group scheduling authorization according to the present invention
  • FIG. 7 is a flow chart of still another embodiment of a method for group scheduling authorization according to the present invention.
  • FIG. 8 is a flowchart of still another embodiment of a method for group scheduling authorization according to the present invention.
  • FIG. 9 is a flowchart of still another embodiment of a method for group scheduling authorization according to the present invention.
  • FIG. 10 is a schematic structural diagram of an embodiment of a user equipment according to the present invention.
  • FIG. 11 is a schematic structural diagram of another embodiment of a user equipment according to the present invention.
  • FIG. 12 is a schematic structural diagram of an embodiment of a base station according to the present invention.
  • FIG. 13 is a schematic structural diagram of an embodiment of a radio network controller according to the present invention.
  • FIG. 14 is a schematic structural diagram of still another embodiment of a user equipment according to the present invention.
  • FIG. 15 is a schematic structural diagram of another embodiment of a base station according to the present invention.
  • FIG. 16 is a schematic structural diagram of another embodiment of a radio network controller according to the present invention.
  • the technical solutions in the embodiments of the present invention are clearly and completely described in the following with reference to the accompanying drawings in the embodiments of the present invention.
  • the embodiments are a part of the embodiments of the invention, and not all of the embodiments. All other embodiments obtained by a person of ordinary skill in the art based on the embodiments of the present invention without creative efforts are within the scope of the present invention.
  • Step 102 The UE receives the configuration message sent by the RNC, where the configuration message carries the E-RNTI.
  • the E-RNTI carried in the configuration message may include an E-RNTI allocated for the group to which the UE belongs.
  • Step 103 The UE monitors the first channel by using the E-RNTI carried in the configuration message, and activates or deactivates the HARQ process according to the absolute authorization received by the UE in the first channel.
  • the foregoing absolute authorization includes an activation or deactivation indication of the HARQ process of the UE, where the activation indication of the HARQ process of the UE is a specific authorization value.
  • the first channel may be an E-AGCH, a common E-AGCH (common E-AGCH), or a non-serving E-AGCH (non-serving E-AGCH).
  • the UE reports the capability of the UE to support the uplink enhanced dedicated channel to the RNC, and receives the configuration message sent by the RNC, and uses the E-RNTI carried in the configuration message to listen to the first channel, where the configuration message is carried.
  • the E-RNTI may include an E-RNTI allocated for the group to which the UE belongs, and then the UE activates or deactivates the HARQ process according to the absolute grant received by the UE in the first channel. Therefore, the E-RNTI allocated for the group to which the UE belongs according to the foregoing configuration message can be used to control all the UEs in a group, thereby implementing the operation of the group activation or deactivation process, and reducing the E-AGCH.
  • the use of the downlink code resource is improved, and the downlink throughput is limited.
  • FIG. 2 is a flowchart of another embodiment of a method for scheduling authorization of a group according to the present invention. As shown in FIG. 2, the method for scheduling authorization of the group may include:
  • Step 201 After receiving the uplink enhanced dedicated channel configuration information of the UE sent by the RNC, the base station configures the E-RNTI for the UE.
  • Step 202 The base station sends the E-RNTI configured for the UE to the RNC, so that the RNC sends the E-RNTI configured by the base station to the UE to the UE.
  • the E-RNTI configured by the base station for the UE may include an E-RNTL allocated by the base station to the group to which the UE belongs.
  • Step 203 The base station sends an absolute authorization of the configured E-RNTI to the UE by using the first channel.
  • the first channel may be an E-AGCH, a common E-AGCH (common E-AGCH), or a non-serving E-AGCH (non-serving E-AGCH).
  • the base station may further receive an indication message sent by the RNC, where the indication message is used to indicate that the base station performs wireless Link configuration message configuration. That is to say, the base station can configure the E-RNTI for the UE after receiving the indication message sent by the RNC.
  • configuring the E-RNTI for the UE may be: the base station configuring the first E-RNTI and the primary E-RNTI for the UE; or, the base station configuring the first E- for the UE RNTI, primary E-RNTI and secondary E-RNTI.
  • the E-RNTI allocated by the base station to the group to which the UE belongs is the first E-RNTI, and the first E-RNTI may be an additional main E-RNTK additional Primary E-RNTI) can also be a group E-RNTK group E-RNTI).
  • the first E-RNTI is common, and the base station configures the same first E-RNTI for all UEs in the group to which the UE belongs.
  • all the UEs in a group can be controlled by the first E-RNTI, thereby implementing the operation of the group activation or deactivation process, reducing the use of the E-AGCH, and improving the downlink code resources. Use efficiency to avoid limited downlink throughput.
  • the base station transmitting, by using the first channel, the absolute authorization of the configured E-RNTI to the UE may be: if the current control requirement is separately controlled, the base station sends the identifier to the UE as the primary E-RNTI by using the first channel. Or absolute authorization; or, if the current control requirement is group control, the base station sends an absolute grant identified by the first E-RNTI to the UE through the first channel.
  • the base station After the base station sends the first E-RNTI of the UE to the RNC, the base station sends the updated first E-RNTI to the RNC. And notifying the RNC to perform the change of the first E-RNTI, so that the RNC sends the updated first E-RNTI to the UE.
  • configuring the E-RNTI for the UE may be: The base station configures the primary E-RNTI and the secondary E-RNTI for the UE.
  • the E-RNTI allocated by the base station to the group to which the UE belongs is a secondary E-RNTI, and the secondary E-RNTI is common, and the base station configures the same secondary E-RNTI for all UEs in the group to which the UE belongs. In this way, all the UEs in a group can be controlled by the secondary E-RNTI, thereby implementing the operation of the group activation or deactivation process, reducing the use of the E-AGCH, and improving the use of the downlink code resources. Efficiency, avoiding limited downlink throughput.
  • the base station transmitting, by using the first channel, the absolute authorization of the configured E-RNTI to the UE may be: if the current control requirement is separately controlled, the base station sends the identifier to the UE as the primary E-RNTI by using the first channel. Or absolute authorization; or, if the current control requirement is group control, the base station sends an absolute grant identified as a secondary E-RNTI to the UE through the first channel.
  • the base station After the base station sends the absolute E-RNTI identified as the configured E-RNTI to the UE by using the first channel, if the base station needs to change the secondary E-RNTI of the UE, the base station sends the updated secondary E-RNTI to the RNC, and Notifying the RNC to make a change in the secondary E-RNTI for the RNC
  • the updated secondary E-RNTI is sent to the UE.
  • configuring the E-RNTI for the UE may be: the base station configuring the primary E-RNTI for the UE; or, the base station configuring the primary E-RNTI and the secondary E-RNTI for the UE.
  • the base station sends the HARQ process information allocated to the UE to the RNC.
  • the HARQ process information may be configuration information of a HARQ process that allows the UE to send data.
  • the base station sends the HARQ process information allocated by the UE to the RNC, so that the base station initially configures or reconfigures the process state of the UE according to the process state information.
  • the base station after the base station sends the absolute authorization of the configured E-RNTI to the UE by using the first channel, the base station sends the process status information of the UE to the RNC, and after receiving the process status information of the UE, the RNC may Configure or not configure the process status of the UE.
  • the process state information of the UE may be one or a combination of the HARQ process activation or deactivation state information of the UE, the load information of the HARQ process, the high and low speed indication message, and the indication authorization message.
  • configuring the E-RNTI for the UE may be: the base station configuring the E-RNTI for the UE according to the current control reference information, where the current control reference information includes: the rate of the UE, the data block of the UE, One or a combination of the process number assigned by the UE, the packet information corresponding to the UE, and the current cell process usage.
  • the foregoing absolute authorization includes an activation or deactivation indication of the HARQ process of the UE, and the activation indication of the HARQ process of the UE is a specific authorization value.
  • FIG. 3 is a flowchart of still another embodiment of a method for scheduling authorization of a group according to the present invention. As shown in FIG. 3, the method for scheduling authorization of the group may include:
  • Step 301 The RNC receives the capability of the UE to support the uplink enhanced dedicated channel reported by the UE.
  • Step 302 The RNC sends the uplink enhanced dedicated channel configuration information of the UE to the base station.
  • the RNC after receiving the capability of the UE to support the uplink enhanced dedicated channel, the RNC sends the uplink enhanced dedicated channel configuration information of the UE to the base station.
  • the uplink enhanced dedicated channel configuration information of the UE includes information such as a frame offset of the uplink enhanced dedicated channel supported by the UE.
  • Step 303 The RNC receives the E-RNTL that is sent by the base station to the UE, and the E-RNTI configured by the base station for the UE may include an E-RNTI allocated by the base station to the group to which the UE belongs.
  • Step S304 The RNC sends the E-RNTI configured by the base station to the UE to the UE, so that the UE monitors the first channel by using the configured E-RNTI, and activates or deactivates the HARQ according to the absolute authorization received in the first channel. process.
  • the first channel may be an E-AGCH or a public E-AGCH (common
  • E-AGCH or non-serving E-AGCH (non-serving E-AGCH).
  • the RNC sends an indication message to the base station, where the indication message is used to indicate the message configuration of the radio link establishment by the base station. That is, the base station may configure the E-RNTL for the UE after receiving the indication message sent by the RNC.
  • the E-RNTI configured by the base station for the UE includes the E-RNTI and the primary E-RNTI; or the E-RNTI configured by the base station for the UE includes the first-RN-RNTL.
  • the E-RNTI allocated by the base station to the group to which the UE belongs is the first E-RNTI, and the first E-RNTI may be an additional primary E-RNTI, or may be a group.
  • E-RNTI group E-RNTI.
  • the first E-RNTI is common, and the base station configures the same first E-RNTI for all UEs in the group to which the UE belongs.
  • the RNC may further receive the updated first E-RNTI sent by the base station, and receive a notification sent by the base station to perform the change of the first E-RNTI; The RNC sends the updated first E-RNTI to the UE.
  • the E-RNTI configured by the base station for the UE includes a primary E-RNTI and a secondary E-RNTI.
  • the E-RNTI allocated by the base station to the group to which the UE belongs is the secondary E-RNTI, and the secondary E-RNTI is common, and the base station configures the same secondary E-RNTI for all the UEs in the group to which the UE belongs. In this way, all the UEs in a group can be controlled by the secondary E-RNTI, thereby implementing the operation of the group activation or deactivation process, reducing the use of the E-AGCH, and improving the use of the downlink code resources. Efficiency, avoiding limited downlink throughput.
  • the RNC may further receive the updated secondary E-RNTI sent by the base station, and receive a notification sent by the base station to perform the change of the secondary E-RNTI; The RNC sends the updated secondary E-RNTI to the UE.
  • the E-RNTI configured by the base station for the UE includes a primary E-RNTI, or the E-RNTI configured by the base station for the UE includes a primary E-RNTI and a secondary E-RNTI.
  • the RNC may further receive the HARQ process information that the base station allocates to the UE.
  • the HARQ process information may be configuration information of a HARQ process that allows the UE to send data.
  • the RNC may further receive the process state information of the UE sent by the base station. Then, the RNC initially configures or reconfigures the process state of the UE according to the process state information.
  • the RNC may further receive the process status information of the UE sent by the base station, and after receiving the process status information of the UE, the RNC may configure or not. Configure the process status of the UE.
  • the process state information of the UE may be one or a combination of the HARQ process activation or deactivation state information of the UE, the load information of the HARQ process, the high and low speed indication message, and the indication authorization message.
  • the RNC after receiving the capability of the UE to support the uplink enhanced dedicated channel, the RNC sends the uplink enhanced dedicated channel configuration information of the UE to the base station, and the received base station sends the E-RNTI configured by the base station to the UE.
  • the E-RNTI configured by the UE transmitting, by the base station, the E-RNTI configured by the UE to the UE, where the E-RNTI configured by the base station for the UE may include a base The E-RNTI allocated by the station to the group to which the UE belongs, so that all the UEs in one group can be controlled according to the E-RNTI allocated by the base station to the group to which the UE belongs, and thus the group activation or De-activation of the process reduces the use of E-AGCH, improves the efficiency of downlink code resources, and avoids limited downlink throughput.
  • FIG. 4 is a flowchart of still another embodiment of a method for scheduling authorization of a group according to the present invention. As shown in FIG. 4, the method for scheduling authorization of the group may include:
  • Step 401 The UE reports the capability of the UE to support the uplink enhanced dedicated channel to the RNC.
  • the UE reporting the capability of the UE to support the uplink enhanced dedicated channel to the RNC may be: the UE reporting the capability of the UE to receive the absolute authorization of the first E-RNTI during the uplink enhanced dedicated channel operation.
  • the UE may report the capability of the UE to receive the absolute authorization of the first E-RNTI by using the RRC connection establishment request or the RRC connection setup complete message to report to the RNC.
  • Step 402 The UE receives a configuration message sent by the RNC, where the configuration message carries an E-RNTI.
  • the E-RNTI carried in the configuration message includes a first E-RNTI and a primary E-RNTI; or the E-RNTI carried in the configuration message includes a first E-RNTI, a primary E-RNTI, and a secondary E-RNTI.
  • the first E-RNTI is an E-RNTI allocated by the base station to the group to which the UE belongs, and the first E-RNTI may be an additional primary E-RNTI or a group E-RNTI. ( group E-RNTI ).
  • group E-RNTI the first E-RNTI is common, and the base station configures the same first E-RNTI for all UEs in the group to which the UE belongs.
  • all the UEs in a group can be controlled by the first E-RNTI, thereby implementing the operation of the group activation or deactivation process, reducing the use of the E-AGCH, and improving the downlink code resources. Use efficiency to avoid limited downlink throughput.
  • the configuration message may be an RRC message such as radio bearer setup, radio bearer reconfiguration, or RRC connection setup.
  • Step 403 The UE uses the E-RNTI carried in the configuration message to listen to the first channel.
  • the UE receives the absolute authorization identified as the E-RNTI or the primary E-RNTI in the first channel, the UE determines that the identifier is The type of absolute authorization of the first E-RNTI or the primary E-RNTI is the primary authorization.
  • the first channel may be an E-AGCH or a common E-AGCH (common E-AGCH) or non-serving E-AGCH (non-serving E-AGCH).
  • Step 404 The UE activates or deactivates the HARQ process according to the absolute authorization received by the UE in the first channel.
  • the UE may activate or deactivate the HARQ process according to the absolute authorization received by the UE in the first channel: if the UE receives the absolute authorized identifier in the first channel.
  • the first E-RNTI, and the absolute authorization value of the above absolute authorization is a deactivation command, when the absolute authorization range of the above absolute authorization is a per HARQ (per HARQ) process and a configured 2 millisecond TTI, the UE deactivates the current TTI.
  • the HARQ process corresponding to the corresponding HARQ process ID or, when the absolute authorization range of the above absolute authorization is all HARQ processes, the 2 ms TTI is configured, and the secondary E-RNTI is not configured, the UE deactivates all HARQ processes; or, when When the absolute authorization range of the above absolute authorization is all HARQ processes and the secondary E-RNTI is configured, the UE activates all HARQ processes, sets the service authorization to store the second authorization value, and sets the primary authorization validity to false;
  • the UE may activate or deactivate the HARQ process according to the absolute authorization received by the UE in the first channel: if the identifier of the absolute authorization received by the UE in the first channel is An E-RNTI, and the absolute authorization value of the above-mentioned absolute authorization is not a deactivation command, and when the absolute authorization range of the absolute authorization is the per-HARQ process, the UE activates the HARQ process corresponding to the HARQ process number corresponding to the current TTI; or When the absolute authorization range of the above absolute authorization is all HARQ processes, the UE activates all HARQ processes.
  • the UE may activate or deactivate the HARQ process according to the absolute authorization received by the UE in the first channel: if the identifier of the absolute authorization received by the UE in the first channel is An E-RNTI, and the absolute authorization value of the above-mentioned absolute authorization is not a deactivation command, the UE activates the HARQ process corresponding to the HARQ process number corresponding to the current TTI, and deactivates the HARQ process number corresponding to the current TTI in all the HARQ processes. The HARQ process outside the corresponding HARQ process.
  • the UE The master authorization validity is set to true if the identifier of the absolute authorization received by the UE in the first channel is the first E-RNTI, and the absolute authorization value of the absolute authorization is not a deactivation command, the UE The master authorization validity is set to true.
  • the UE if the identifier of the absolute authorization received by the UE in the first channel is the first E-RNTI, and the absolute authorization value of the foregoing absolute authorization is not deactivated The UE starts the timer when the absolute authorized timer is in the untriggered state, or when the absolute authorized timer is in the trigger state, the UE resets the timer.
  • the UE sets the service authorization to the maximum value of the above absolute authorization value and the minimum configuration service authorization value; or, when the above absolute authorization is performed When the absolute authorization value is zero for the authorization command, the UE sets the service authorization to zero authorization.
  • the UE reports to the RNC that the UE supports the capability of receiving the absolute authorization of the first E-RNTI during the uplink enhanced dedicated channel operation, and receives the configuration message sent by the RNC, and then the UE uses the configuration message to carry.
  • the E-RNTI is configured to listen to the first channel, where the E-RNTI carried in the configuration message includes a first E-RNTI allocated for the group to which the UE belongs; and then the UE activates according to the absolute authorization received by the UE in the first channel. Or deactivate the HARQ process.
  • all the UEs in a group can be controlled according to the first E-RNTI carried in the configuration message, and the activation or deactivation process of the group can be implemented, the use of the E-AGCH is reduced, and the downlink is improved.
  • the efficiency of the use of code resources avoids limited downlink throughput.
  • FIG. 5 is a flowchart of still another embodiment of a method for scheduling authorization of a group according to the present invention. As shown in FIG. 5, the method for scheduling authorization of the group may include:
  • Step 501 The RNC sends the uplink enhanced dedicated channel configuration information of the UE by using the first message when the RNC receives the capability that the UE supports receiving the absolute authorization of the first E-RNTI during the uplink enhanced dedicated channel operation. To the base station.
  • the uplink enhanced dedicated channel configuration information of the UE includes information such as a frame offset of the uplink enhanced dedicated channel supported by the UE.
  • the foregoing first message may be a message such as radio link establishment, radio link addition, or radio link reconfiguration.
  • Step 502 The base station configures the E-RNTI to the UE according to the current control reference information, and the E-RNTI configured by the base station for the UE is notified to the RNC by using the second message.
  • the E-RNTI configured by the base station to the foregoing UE may include a first E-RNTI and a primary E-RNTI; or, the E-RNTI configured by the base station to the UE may include a first E-RNTI, a primary E-RNTI, and a secondary E-RNTI.
  • the first E-RNTI is an E-RNTI allocated by the base station to the group to which the UE belongs, and the first E-RNTI may be an additional primary E-RNTI or a group E-RNTI. ( group E-RNTI ).
  • group E-RNTI the first E-RNTI is common, and the base station configures the same first E-RNTI for all UEs in the group to which the UE belongs. In this way, all the UEs in a group can be controlled by the first E-RNTI, thereby implementing the operation of the group activation or deactivation process, reducing the use of the E-AGCH, and improving the downlink code resources. Use efficiency to avoid limited downlink throughput.
  • the current control reference information may be: one of a combination of the rate of the UE, the data block of the UE, the process ID assigned by the UE, the packet information corresponding to the UE, and the current cell process usage.
  • the foregoing second message may be a message such as a radio link setup response message, a radio link add response message, a radio link reconfiguration response message, or a radio link parameter update message.
  • Step 503 When the RNC receives the E-RNTI configured by the base station for the UE, the RNC sends the E-RNTI configured by the base station to the UE to the UE by using a third message.
  • the foregoing third message may be an RRC message such as radio bearer setup, radio bearer reconfiguration, or RRC connection setup.
  • Step 504 The base station selects an E-RNTI according to the current control requirement, and sends an absolute authorization identified by the selected E-RNTI to the UE by using the first channel.
  • the base station selects the primary E-RNTI, and sends an absolute authorization identified by the primary E-RNTI to the UE by using the first channel; or, if the current control requirement is group control, The base station selects the first E-RNTI and transmits an absolute grant identified as the E-RNTI to the UE through the first channel.
  • step 504 if the base station needs to change the number of the UE
  • the updated first E-RNTI can be sent to the RNC through the second message, and the RNC is notified to change the E-RNTI.
  • the RNC sends the updated first E-RNTI to the UE through the third message.
  • the base station may further perform the 2 millisecond HARQ process of the UE.
  • the usage information informs the RNC via the second message.
  • the specific process usage information may be activation or deactivation of each process, or whether each process is zero authorized.
  • the RNC may further send an indication message to the base station, where the indication message is used to indicate that the base station performs message configuration for establishing a radio link. That is, the base station may configure the E-RNTI for the UE after receiving the indication message sent by the RNC.
  • all the UEs in a group can be controlled according to the first E-RNTI allocated by the base station to the group to which the UE belongs, and the operation of the group activation or deactivation process can be implemented, and the E-AGCH is reduced.
  • the use of the downlink code resource is improved, and the downlink throughput is limited.
  • FIG. 6 is a flowchart of still another embodiment of a method for scheduling authorization of a group according to the present invention. As shown in FIG. 6, the method for scheduling authorization of the group may include:
  • Step 601 The UE reports the capability of the UE to support the uplink enhanced dedicated channel to the RNC.
  • the UE reports the capability of the UE to support the uplink enhanced dedicated channel to the RNC, that is, implicitly informs the RNC that the UE supports the capability of receiving the absolute authorization of the primary E-RNTI and the secondary E-RNTI.
  • Step 602 The UE receives a configuration message sent by the RNC, where the configuration message carries a primary E-RNTI and a secondary E-RNTL.
  • the secondary E-RNTI is an E-RNTI allocated by the base station to the group to which the UE belongs, and the secondary E-RNTI is common, and the base station configures the same secondary E-RNTI for all UEs in the group to which the UE belongs. In this way, all the UEs in a group can be controlled by the secondary E-RNTI, thereby implementing the operation of the group activation or deactivation process, reducing the use of the E-AGCH, and improving the use of the downlink code resources. Efficiency, avoiding limited downlink throughput.
  • the foregoing configuration message may be an RRC message such as a radio bearer setup message, a radio bearer reconfiguration, or an RRC connection setup.
  • Step 603 The UE uses the foregoing primary E-RNTI and the secondary E-RNTI to monitor the first channel.
  • the first channel may be an E-AGCH, a common E-AGCH (common E-AGCH), or a non-serving E-AGCH (non-serving E-AGCH).
  • Step 604 The UE activates or deactivates the HARQ process according to the absolute authorization received by the UE in the first channel. Specifically, when the UE receives the absolute authorization identified as the secondary E-RNTI in the first channel, the UE determines, according to the absolute authorization range of the absolute authorization, the range of the active process identified as the secondary authorization of the secondary E-RNTI.
  • the UE may activate or deactivate the HARQ process according to the absolute authorization received by the UE in the first channel: if the identifier of the absolute authorization received by the UE in the first channel is E-RNTI, and the absolute authorization value of the above-mentioned absolute authorization is a deactivation command.
  • the absolute authorization range of the above-mentioned absolute authorization is the per-HARQ process and the configured T-second TTI
  • the UE deactivates the HARQ process number corresponding to the current TTI.
  • the HARQ process or, when the absolute authorization range of the above absolute authorization is all HARQ processes and the configured 2 ms TTI, the UE deactivates all HARQ processes;
  • the UE may activate or deactivate the HARQ process according to the absolute authorization received by the UE in the first channel: if the identifier of the absolute authorization received by the UE in the first channel is E-RNTI, and the absolute authorization value of the above-mentioned absolute authorization is not a deactivation command, and when the absolute authorization range of the absolute authorization is the per-HARQ process, the UE activates the HARQ process corresponding to the HARQ process number corresponding to the current TTI; or When the absolute authorization range of the above absolute authorization is all HARQ processes, the UE activates all HARQ processes.
  • the UE may activate or deactivate the HARQ process according to the absolute authorization received by the UE in the first channel: if the identifier of the absolute authorization received by the UE in the first channel is E-RNTI, and the absolute authorization value of the above-mentioned absolute authorization is not a deactivation command, the UE activates the HARQ process corresponding to the current HARQ process ID, and deactivates the HARQ process number corresponding to the current TTI in all HARQ processes. The HARQ process outside the HARQ process.
  • the UE sets the service authorization to the maximum value of the above absolute authorization value and the minimum configuration service authorization value; or, when the above absolute authorization value is a zero authorization command, the UE sets the service authorization to zero authorization.
  • the foregoing absolute authorization is performed.
  • the timer is in the untriggered state, the UE starts the above setting. Or the UE resets the timer when the above-mentioned absolute authorized timer is in a triggered state.
  • the UE reports the capability of the UE to support the uplink enhanced dedicated channel to the RNC, and receives the configuration message sent by the RNC, and then the UE uses the E-RNTI carried in the configuration message to listen to the first channel, where the configuration message is received.
  • the carried E-RNTI may include a secondary E-RNTI allocated by the base station to the group to which the UE belongs. The UE then activates or deactivates the HARQ process based on the absolute grant received by the UE in the first channel.
  • the secondary E-RNTI carried in the configuration message can be used to control all the UEs in a group, thereby implementing the operation of the group activation or deactivation process, reducing the use of the E-AGCH, and improving the downlink code.
  • the efficiency of resource usage avoids limited downlink throughput.
  • FIG. 7 is a flowchart of still another embodiment of a method for scheduling authorization of a group according to the present invention. As shown in FIG. 7, the method for scheduling authorization of the group may include:
  • Step 701 When the RNC receives the capability of the UE to support the uplink enhanced dedicated channel, the RNC sends the uplink enhanced dedicated channel configuration information of the UE to the base station by using the first message.
  • the uplink enhanced dedicated channel configuration information of the UE includes information such as a frame offset of the uplink enhanced dedicated channel supported by the UE.
  • the foregoing first message may be a message such as radio link establishment, radio link addition, or radio link reconfiguration.
  • Step 702 The base station configures the E-RNTI to the UE according to the current control reference information, and the E-RNTI configured by the base station for the UE is notified to the RNC by using the second message.
  • the E-RNTI configured by the base station to the UE includes a primary E-RNTI and a secondary E-RNTI.
  • the secondary E-RNTI is an E-RNTI allocated by the base station to a group to which the UE belongs, and the secondary E-RNTI is public.
  • the base station configures the same secondary E-RNTI for all UEs in the group to which the UE belongs. In this way, all the UEs in a group can be controlled by the secondary E-RNTI, thereby implementing the operation of the group activation or deactivation process, reducing the use of the E-AGCH, and improving the use of the downlink code resources. Efficiency, avoiding limited downlink throughput.
  • the current control reference information may be: one or a combination of the rate of the UE, the data block of the UE, the process number assigned by the UE, the packet information corresponding to the UE, and the current cell process usage.
  • the foregoing second message may be a message such as a radio link setup response message, a radio link add response message, a radio link reconfiguration response message, or a radio link parameter update message.
  • Step 703 When the RNC receives the E-RNTI configured by the base station for the UE, the RNC sends the E-RNTI configured by the base station to the UE to the UE by using a third message.
  • the foregoing third message may be a radio bearer setup, a radio bearer reconfiguration, or
  • the RRC connection establishes an RRC message.
  • Step 704 The base station selects an E-RNTI according to the current control requirement, and sends an absolute authorization identified by the selected E-RNTI to the UE by using the first channel.
  • the base station selects the primary E-RNTI, and sends an absolute authorization identified by the primary E-RNTI to the UE by using the first channel; or, if the current control requirement is group control, The base station selects the secondary E-RNTI, and sends an absolute grant identified as the secondary E-RNTI to the UE through the first channel.
  • the updated secondary E-RNTI may be sent to the RNC by using the second message, and the RNC is notified to perform the change of the secondary E-RNTI.
  • the RNC sends the updated secondary E-RNTI to the UE through the third message.
  • the RNC may send the E-RNTI configured by the base station to the RNC through the second message, and the RNC may further send the information to the foregoing base station.
  • An indication message the indication message is used to indicate a message configuration of the base station to perform radio link establishment. That is, the base station may configure the E-RNTI for the UE after receiving the indication message sent by the RNC.
  • all the UEs in a group can be controlled according to the secondary E-RNTI allocated by the base station to the group to which the UE belongs, thereby implementing the operation of the group activation or deactivation process, and reducing the E-AGCH.
  • the use of the downlink code resource is improved, and the downlink throughput is limited.
  • FIG. 8 is a flowchart of still another embodiment of a method for scheduling authorization of a group according to the present invention. As shown in FIG. 8, the method for scheduling authorization of the group may include:
  • Step 801 The UE reports the capability of the UE to support the uplink enhanced dedicated channel to the RNC.
  • the UE reports the capability of the UE to support the uplink enhanced dedicated channel to the RNC, that is, implicitly informs the RNC that the UE supports the absolute authorization or identifier of the primary E-RNTI as the receiving identifier.
  • Step 802 The UE receives a configuration message sent by the RNC, where the configuration message carries an E-RNTI.
  • the configuration message may be an RRC message such as a radio bearer setup message, a radio bearer reconfiguration, or an RRC connection setup.
  • the E-RNTI carried in the configuration message includes a primary E-RNTI; or the E-RNTI carried in the configuration message includes a primary E-RNTI and a secondary E-RNTI.
  • Step 803 The UE uses the E-RNTI carried in the configuration message to listen to the first channel, when
  • the UE determines that the identifier is the primary
  • the type of absolute authorization of E-RNTI is the primary authorization.
  • Step 804 The UE activates or deactivates the HARQ process according to the absolute authorization received by the UE in the first channel.
  • the UE may activate or deactivate the HARQ process according to the absolute authorization received by the UE in the first channel: if the UE receives the absolute authorization in the first channel.
  • the primary E-RNTI is identified, and the absolute authorization value of the absolute authorization is a deactivation command.
  • the UE deactivates the HARQ process corresponding to the current TTI.
  • the HARQ process corresponding to the number; or, when the absolute authorization range of the above absolute authorization is all HARQ processes, the configured 2 milliseconds TTI, and the secondary E-RNTI are not configured, the UE deactivates all HARQ processes; or, when the above-mentioned absolute authorization is performed When the absolute authorization range is all HARQ processes and the secondary E-RNTI is configured, the UE activates all HARQ processes, sets the service authorization to store the second authorization value, and sets the primary authorization validity to false.
  • the UE may activate or deactivate the HARQ process according to the absolute authorization received by the UE in the first channel: if the identifier of the absolute authorization received by the UE in the first channel is E-RNTI, and the absolute authorization value of the above-mentioned absolute authorization is not a deactivation command, and when the absolute authorization range of the above-mentioned absolute authorization is the per-HARQ process, the UE deactivates the HARQ process corresponding to the HARQ process number corresponding to the current TTI; or When the absolute authorization range of the above absolute authorization is all HARQ processes, the UE activates all HARQ processes.
  • the UE sets the primary authorization validity to true.
  • the identifier of the absolute authorization received by the UE in the first channel is the primary E-RNTI, and the absolute authorization value of the absolute authorization is not a deactivation command, then the above-mentioned absolute authorization is performed.
  • the timer is in an untriggered state, the UE starts the timer, or when the above-mentioned absolute authorized timer is in a triggered state, the UE resets the timer.
  • the UE sets the service authorization to the maximum value of the above absolute authorization value and the minimum configuration service authorization value; or, when the absolute authorization value of the above absolute authorization is zero When the command is granted, the UE sets the service authorization to zero authorization.
  • the UE reports the capability of the UE to support the uplink enhanced dedicated channel to the RNC, and receives the configuration message sent by the RNC, and then the UE uses the E-RNTI carried in the configuration message to listen to the first channel, and according to the UE.
  • the absolute grant received in the first channel activates or deactivates the HARQ process. This makes it possible to activate or deactivate the process.
  • Step 901 When the RNC receives the capability of the UE to support the uplink enhanced dedicated channel, the RNC sends the uplink enhanced dedicated channel configuration information of the UE to the base station by using the first message.
  • the foregoing first message may be a message such as radio link establishment, radio link addition, or radio link reconfiguration.
  • Step 902 The base station configures the E-RNTI to the UE according to the current control reference information, and sends the E-RNTI configured by the base station to the UE and the HARQ process information allocated by the base station to the UE to the RNC by using a second message.
  • the HARQ process information may be configuration information of a HARQ process that allows the UE to send data.
  • the foregoing second message may be a message such as a radio link setup response message, a radio link add response message, a radio link reconfiguration response message, or a radio link parameter update message.
  • Step 903 When the RNC receives the E-RNTI configured by the base station for the UE, the RNC sends the E-RNTI configured by the base station to the UE to the UE by using a third message.
  • the foregoing third message may be an RRC message such as radio bearer setup, radio bearer reconfiguration, or RRC connection setup.
  • Step 904 The base station selects an E-RNTI according to the current control requirement, and sends an absolute authorization identified by the selected E-RNTI to the UE by using the first channel.
  • the foregoing absolute authorization includes an activation or deactivation indication of the HARQ process of the UE, and the activation indication of the HARQ process of the UE is a specific authorization value.
  • step 902 after the base station sends the E-RNTI configured by the base station to the UE and the HARQ process information allocated by the base station to the UE is sent to the RNC through the second message, the base station may further process the UE.
  • the status information is sent to the RNC, and then the RNC initially configures or reconfigures the process status information of the UE according to the process status information of the UE.
  • the RNC may initially configure or reconfigure the process state of the UE according to the process state information of the UE.
  • the RNC may perform the process state of the at least two UEs according to the process state information of the at least two UEs.
  • the RNC can control all UEs in a group, thereby implementing the operation of the group activation or deactivation process, reducing the use of the E-AGCH, and improving the use of the downlink code resources. Efficiency, avoiding limited downlink throughput.
  • the process state information of the UE may be one or a combination of the HARQ process activation or deactivation state information of the UE, the load information of the HARQ process, the high and low speed indication message, and the indication authorization message.
  • the foregoing embodiment can implement the RNC to configure the process state of the UE according to the process state information of the UE, and further control all UEs in a group, and then The operation of activating or deactivating a group is implemented, which reduces the use of E-AGCH, improves the efficiency of using downlink code resources, and avoids limited downlink throughput.
  • FIG. 10 is a schematic structural diagram of an embodiment of a user equipment according to the present invention.
  • the UE in this embodiment may implement the process of the embodiment shown in FIG. 1 of the present invention.
  • the UE may include: a reporting module 1001, and a receiving module. 1002.
  • the reporting module 1001 is configured to report, to the RNC, the capability of the UE to support an uplink enhanced dedicated channel.
  • the receiving module 1002 is configured to receive a configuration message sent by the RNC, where the configuration message carries an E-RNTI, where the E-RNTI carried in the configuration message may include an E-RNTI allocated to a group to which the UE belongs;
  • the first channel may be an E-AGCH or a public E-AGCH (common
  • E-AGCH or non-serving E-AGCH (non-serving E-AGCH).
  • the foregoing absolute authorization includes an activation or deactivation indication of the HARQ process of the UE, and the activation indication of the HARQ process of the UE is a specific authorization value.
  • the reporting module 1001 reports the capability of the UE to support the uplink enhanced dedicated channel to the RNC, and the receiving module 1002 receives the configuration message sent by the RNC, and then the listening module 1003 monitors the first channel by using the E-RNTI carried in the configuration message.
  • the E-RNTI carried in the configuration message may include an E-RNTI allocated for the group to which the UE belongs; the activation/deactivation module 1004 activates or deactivates the HARQ according to the absolute authorization received by the listening module 1003 in the first channel. process. Therefore, all the UEs in a group can be controlled according to the E-RNTI allocated for the group to which the UE belongs according to the configuration message, and the group can be implemented.
  • the activation or deactivation process reduces the use of E-AGCH, improves the efficiency of downlink code resources, and avoids limited downlink throughput.
  • FIG. 11 is a schematic structural diagram of another embodiment of a user equipment according to the present invention. Compared with the UE shown in FIG. 10, the difference is that, in an implementation manner of this embodiment, the configuration message received by the receiving module 1002 carries the E.
  • the RNTI includes the first E-RNTI and the primary E-RNTI.
  • the E-RNTI carried in the configuration message received by the receiving module 1002 includes the first E-RNTI, the primary E-RNTI, and the secondary E-RNTI.
  • the E-RNTI allocated to the group to which the UE belongs is the E-RNTI, and the E-RNTI may be an additional Primary E-RNTI or a group E-RNTI (group) E-RNTI)
  • the first E-RNTI is common, and the base station configures the same first E-RNTI for all UEs in the group to which the UE belongs. In this way, all the UEs in a group can be controlled by the first E-RNTI, thereby implementing the operation of the group activation or deactivation process, reducing the use of the E-AGCH, and improving the downlink code resources. Use efficiency to avoid limited downlink throughput.
  • the UE may further include: a first determining module 1005;
  • the first determining module 1005 is configured to activate or deactivate the activation/deactivation module 1004
  • the listening module 1003 receives the absolute authorization identified as the first E-RNTI or the primary E-RNTI in the first channel, determining the type of the absolute authorization identified as the E-RNTI or the primary E-RNTI Main authorization.
  • the activation/deactivation module 1004 is specifically configured to: when the monitoring module 1003 receives the absolute authorization identifier in the first channel, the first E-RNTI, and the above-mentioned absolute authorization
  • the absolute authorization value is not the deactivation command, if the above is absolutely
  • the absolute authorization range for the authorization is the HARQ process corresponding to the HARQ process number corresponding to the current TTI for each HARQ process; or, if the absolute authorization range of the above absolute authorization is all HARQ processes, all HARQ processes are activated.
  • the activation/deactivation module 1004 is specifically configured to: when the monitoring module 1003 receives the absolute authorization identifier in the first channel as the first E-RNTI, and the above-mentioned absolute authorization When the absolute authorization value is not the deactivation command, the HARQ process corresponding to the HARQ process number corresponding to the current TTI is activated, and the HARQ process except the HARQ process corresponding to the HARQ process number corresponding to the current TTI is activated in all the HARQ processes.
  • the foregoing UE may further include: a first setting module 1006;
  • the first setting module 1006 is configured to: when the absolute authorization identifier received by the listening module 1003 in the first channel is the first E-RNTI, and the absolute authorization value of the absolute authorization is not the deactivation command, the primary authorization is performed. Validity is set to true;
  • the first setting module 1006 is configured to: when the identifier of the absolute authorization received by the listening module 1003 in the first channel is the first E-RNTI, and the absolute authorization value of the absolute authorization is not the deactivation command, if the above-mentioned absolute authorization is The timer is started when the timer is in an untriggered state, or the timer is reset if the above-mentioned absolute authorized timer is in a triggered state; or
  • the first setting module 1006 is configured to: when the monitoring module 1003 receives the absolute authorization identifier in the first channel, the first E-RNTI, the primary E-RNTI, or the primary authorization validity is set to false, and the absolute authorization is absolute.
  • the authorization value is not the deactivation command, if the absolute authorization value of the above absolute authorization is not a zero authorization command, the service authorization is set to the maximum value of the absolute authorization value and the minimum configuration service authorization value; or, if the above absolute authorization is If the absolute authorization value is zero, the service authorization is set to zero authorization.
  • the upper module 1001 is specifically configured to support the RNC to receive the absolute identity of the first E-RNTI during the uplink enhanced dedicated channel operation.
  • the E-RNTI carried in the configuration message received by the receiving module 1002 includes a primary E-RNTI and a secondary E-RNTI.
  • the base station allocates E- to the group to which the UE belongs.
  • the RNTI is a secondary E-RNTI
  • the secondary E-RNTI is public
  • the base station is a UE. All UEs in the group are configured with the same secondary E-RNTI. In this way, all the UEs in a group can be controlled by the secondary E-RNTI, thereby implementing the activation or deactivation process of the group, reducing the use of the E-AGCH, and improving the use of the downlink code resources. Efficiency, avoiding limited downlink throughput.
  • the activation/deactivation module 1004 is specifically configured to: when the monitoring module 1003 receives the absolute authorization identifier in the first channel, the secondary E-RNTI, and the absolute authorization of the absolute authorization. If the absolute authorization range of the absolute authorization is the per-HARQ process and the configured 2 ms TTI, the HARQ process corresponding to the HARQ process number corresponding to the current TTI is deactivated; or, if the above absolute authorization is absolute The authorization range is for all HARQ processes and the configured 2 ms TTI, then all HARQ processes are deactivated.
  • the activation/deactivation module 1004 is specifically configured to: when the monitoring module 1003 receives the absolute authorization identifier in the first channel, the secondary E-RNTI, and the absolute absolute authorization. If the authorization value is not the deactivation command, if the absolute authorization range of the absolute authorization is the per-HARQ process, the HARQ process corresponding to the HARQ process number corresponding to the current TTI is activated; or if the absolute authorization scope of the above absolute authorization is all HARQ processes. , then activate all HARQ processes.
  • the activation/deactivation module 1004 is specifically configured to: when the monitoring module 1003 receives the absolute authorization identifier in the first channel as the secondary E-RNTI, and the absolute absolute authorization is performed.
  • the authorization value is not the deactivation command
  • the HARQ process corresponding to the HARQ process number corresponding to the current TTI is activated, and the HARQ process except the HARQ process corresponding to the HARQ process number corresponding to the current TTI is activated in all the HARQ processes.
  • the second setting module 1007 is configured to: when the identifier of the absolute authorization received by the listening module 1003 in the first channel is a secondary E-RNTI, and the absolute authorization value of the absolute authorization is not a deactivation command, if the absolute authorization value is If it is not a zero authorization command, the service authorization is set to the maximum value of the above absolute authorization value and the minimum configuration service authorization value; or, if the above absolute authorization value is a zero authorization command, the service authorization is set to zero authorization;
  • the E-RNTI carried in the configuration message received by the receiving module 1002 includes the primary E-RNTI; or the E-RNTI carried in the configuration message received by the receiving module 1002 includes the primary E-RNTI and the secondary E-RNTI;
  • the UE may further include: a second determining module 1008;
  • the foregoing second determining module 1008 is configured to: when the activation module/deactivation module 1004 activates or deactivates the HARQ process, when the monitoring module 1003 receives the absolute authorization that identifies the primary E-RNTI in the first channel, determining that the identifier is the primary The type of absolute authorization of E-RNTI is the primary authorization.
  • the activation/deactivation module 1004 is specifically configured to: when the monitoring module 1003 receives the absolute authorization identifier in the first channel, the primary E-RNTI, and the absolute authorization of the foregoing absolute authorization. If the absolute authorization range of the absolute authorization is the per-HARQ process and the configured 2 ms TTI, the HARQ process corresponding to the HARQ process number corresponding to the current TTI is deactivated; or, if the above absolute authorization is absolute If the authorization range is all HARQ processes, the configured 2 ms TTI, and the secondary E-RNTI are not configured, all HARQ processes are deactivated; or, if the absolute authorization range of the above absolute authorization is all HARQ processes and configured secondary E-RNTIs, then Activate all HARQ processes, set the service authorization to store the second authorization value, and set the primary authorization validity to false.
  • the activation/deactivation module 1004 is specifically configured to: when the monitoring module 1003 receives the absolute authorization identifier in the first channel as the primary E-RNTI, and the absolute absolute authorization is performed. If the authorization value is not the deactivation command, if the absolute authorization range of the absolute authorization is the per-HARQ process, the HARQ process corresponding to the HARQ process number corresponding to the current TTI is deactivated; or if the absolute authorization range of the above absolute authorization is all HARQs. The process activates all HARQ processes.
  • the foregoing UE may further include: a third setting module 1009;
  • the third setting module 1009 is configured to: when the absolute authorization identifier received by the monitoring module 1003 in the first channel is the primary E-RNTI, and the absolute authorization value of the absolute authorization is not the deactivation command, the primary authorization validity is performed. Set to true; or,
  • the third setting module 1009 is configured to: when the absolute authorization identifier received by the monitoring module 1003 in the first channel is the primary E-RNTI, and the absolute authorization value of the absolute authorization is not the deactivation command, if the absolute authorization timing is The timer is started when the device is in an untriggered state, or the timer is reset if the above-mentioned absolute authorized timer is in a triggered state; or
  • the third setting module 1009 is configured to: when the monitoring module 1003 receives the absolute authorization identifier in the first channel as the primary E-RNTI or the primary authorization validity is set to false, and the absolute authorization value of the absolute authorization is not the deactivation command. If the absolute authorization value of the above absolute authorization is not a zero authorization command, set the service authorization to the maximum value of the above absolute authorization value and the minimum configuration service authorization value; or, if the above absolute authorization absolute authorization value is zero authorization command , then set the service authorization to zero authorization.
  • the above embodiment may implement control of all UEs in a group according to the E-RNTI allocated for the group to which the UE belongs according to the foregoing configuration message, thereby implementing the operation of the group activation or deactivation process, and reducing the E-
  • the use of AGCH improves the efficiency of downlink code resources and avoids limited downlink throughput.
  • FIG. 12 is a schematic structural diagram of an embodiment of a base station according to the present invention.
  • the base station in this embodiment may implement the process of the embodiment shown in FIG. 2 of the present invention.
  • the base station may include: a receiving module 1201 and a configuration module 1202. And sending module 1203;
  • the receiving module 1201 is configured to receive uplink enhanced dedicated channel configuration information of the UE sent by the RNC.
  • the configuration module 1202 is configured to: after the receiving module 1201 receives the uplink enhanced dedicated channel configuration information of the UE, configure the E-RNTI for the UE.
  • the E-RNTI configured by the configuration module 1202 for the UE may include the configuration module 1202 being the UE.
  • the sending module 1203 is configured to send, to the RNC, the E-RNTI configured by the configuration module 1202 for the UE, and send an absolute authorization that is identified as the configured E-RNTI to the UE by using the first channel.
  • the first channel may be an E-AGCH, a common E-AGCH (common E-AGCH), or a non-serving E-AGCH (non-serving E-AGCH).
  • the configuration module 1202 is specifically configured to configure the UE.
  • An E-RNTI and a primary E-RNTI; or, the first E-RNTI, the primary E-RNTI, and the secondary E-RNTI are configured for the UE; in this implementation manner, the configuration module 1202 allocates the E-RNTI to the group to which the UE belongs.
  • the first E-RNTI may be an additional primary E-RNTK additional Primary E-RNTI or a group E-RNTI (group E-RNTI).
  • group E-RNTI group E-RNTI
  • the first E-RNTI is common, and the configuration module 1202 configures the same first E-RNTI for all UEs in the group to which the UE belongs.
  • all UEs in a group can be controlled by the first E-RNTI, thereby implementing the operation of the group activation or deactivation process, reducing the use of the E-AGCH, and improving the downlink code resources. Use efficiency to avoid limited downlink throughput.
  • the sending, by the sending module 1203, the absolute authorization that is sent to the UE by using the first channel to be configured as the configured E-RNTI may be: the sending module 1203, specifically, when the current control requirement is the individual control, the first channel is used. Sending an absolute authorization to the UE as the primary E-RNTI; or, when the current control requirement is group control, transmitting the absolute authorization identified as the first E-RNTI to the UE through the first channel.
  • the sending module 1203 is further configured to send the updated first E-RNTI to the RNC when the base station needs to change the first E-RNTI of the UE after transmitting the absolute authorization identified as the configured E-RNTI to the UE. And notifying the RNC to perform the change of the first E-RNTI, so that the RNC sends the updated first E-RNTI to the UE.
  • the configuration module 1202 is specifically configured to configure a primary E-RNTI and a secondary E-RNTI for the UE.
  • the configuration module 1202 allocates the E-RNTI to the group to which the UE belongs to the secondary E-RNTI, and the secondary E-RNTI is common, and the configuration module 1202 configures the same auxiliary for all the UEs in the group to which the UE belongs. E-RNTI.
  • all the UEs in a group can be controlled by the secondary E-RNTI, thereby implementing the operation of the group activation or deactivation process, reducing the use of the E-AGCH, and improving the use of the downlink code resources. Efficiency, avoiding limited downlink throughput.
  • the sending, by the sending module 1203, the absolute authorization that is sent to the UE by using the first channel to be configured as the configured E-RNTI may be: the sending module 1203, specifically, when the current control requirement is the individual control, the first channel is used. Sending an absolute authorization that identifies the primary E-RNTI to the UE; or, when the current control requirement is group control, transmitting an absolute grant identified as a secondary E-RNTI to the UE through the first channel.
  • the sending module 1203 is further configured to send, to the UE, an E-RNTI that is identified as configured.
  • the updated secondary E-RNTI is sent to the RNC, and the RNC is notified to perform the change of the secondary E-RNTI, so that the RNC updates the secondary E-RNTI. Send to the UE.
  • the configuration module 1202 is specifically configured to configure a primary E-RNTI for the UE, or configure a primary E-RNTI and a secondary E-RNTI for the UE.
  • the sending module 1203 is further configured to: after the configuration module 1202 configures the E-RNTI for the UE, send the HARQ process information allocated by the configuration module 1202 to the UE to the RNC.
  • the HARQ process information may be configuration information of a HARQ process that allows the UE to send data.
  • the sending module 1203 is further configured to send the process state information of the UE to the RNC after the HARQ process information allocated by the configuration module 1202 for the UE is sent to the RNC, so that the RNC initially configures or reconfigures according to the process state information.
  • the process status of the UE is further configured to send the process state information of the UE to the RNC after the HARQ process information allocated by the configuration module 1202 for the UE is sent to the RNC, so that the RNC initially configures or reconfigures according to the process state information.
  • the process status of the UE is further configured to send the process state information of the UE to the RNC after the HARQ process information allocated by the configuration module 1202 for the UE is sent to the RNC, so that the RNC initially configures or reconfigures according to the process state information.
  • the process status of the UE is further configured to send the process state information of the UE to the RNC after the HARQ process information allocated by the configuration module 1202 for the UE is
  • the sending module 1203 is further configured to: after sending the absolute authorization that is configured as the configured E-RNTI to the UE, send the process state information of the UE to the RNC, and then, after receiving the process state information of the UE, the RNC
  • the process state of the UE can be configured or not configured.
  • the process state information of the UE may be one or a combination of the HARQ process activation or deactivation state information of the UE, the load information of the HARQ process, the high and low speed indication message, and the indication authorization message.
  • the receiving module 1201 is further configured to: after receiving the uplink enhanced dedicated channel configuration information of the UE that is sent by the RNC, before the E-RNTI is configured for the UE, the configuration module 1202 receives an indication message sent by the RNC, where the indication message is used.
  • a message configuration indicating that the base station performs radio link establishment. That is, the base station may configure the E-RNTI for the UE after receiving the indication message sent by the RNC.
  • the configuration module 1202 is specifically configured to configure an E-RNTI for the UE according to the current control reference information.
  • the current control reference information includes: a rate of the UE, a data block of the UE, and a process that is allocated by the UE. No., one or a combination of the packet information corresponding to the foregoing UE and the current cell process usage.
  • the configuration module 1202 configures the E-RNTI for the UE.
  • the sending module 1203 sends the E-RNTI configured for the UE to the RNC.
  • the E-RNTI configured by the base station for the UE is sent by the RNC to the UE, where the E-RNTI configured by the base station for the UE may be
  • the E-RNTI is allocated by the base station to the group to which the UE belongs; so that all the UEs in a group can be controlled according to the E-RNTI allocated by the base station to the group to which the UE belongs, and the group activation can be implemented. Or deactivating the operation of the process, reducing the use of the E-AGCH, improving the use efficiency of the downlink code resources, and avoiding the limitation of the downlink throughput.
  • FIG. 13 is a schematic structural diagram of an embodiment of a radio network controller according to the present invention.
  • the RNC in this embodiment may implement the process of the embodiment shown in FIG. 3 of the present invention.
  • the RNC may include: a receiving module 1301 and Sending module 1302;
  • the receiving module 1301 is configured to receive, by the UE, the capability of the UE to support the uplink enhanced dedicated channel, and after the sending module 1302 sends the uplink enhanced dedicated channel configuration information of the UE to the base station, the receiving base station sends the base station as the UE.
  • the configured E-RNTI; the E-RNTI configured by the base station for the UE may include an E-RNTI allocated by the base station to the group to which the UE belongs;
  • the sending module 1302 is configured to send the uplink enhanced dedicated channel configuration information of the UE to the base station, and after the receiving module 1301 receives the E-RNTI configured by the base station and configured by the base station, the E-RNTI configured by the base station for the UE.
  • the UE in order for the UE to listen to the first channel with the configured E-RNTI, and activate or deactivate the HARQ process according to the absolute grant received in the first channel.
  • the sending module 1302 sends the uplink enhanced dedicated channel configuration information of the UE to the base station.
  • the uplink enhanced dedicated channel configuration information of the UE includes information such as a frame offset of the uplink enhanced dedicated channel supported by the UE.
  • the first channel may be an E-AGCH, a common E-AGCH (common E-AGCH), or a non-serving E-AGCH (non-serving E-AGCH).
  • the E-RNTI configured by the receiving module 1301 for the UE includes the first E-RNTI and the primary E-RNTI; or the E-RNTI configured by the receiving module 1301 is configured by the UE.
  • the first E-RNTI, the primary E-RNTI, and the secondary E-RNTI are included.
  • the E-RNTI allocated by the base station to the group to which the UE belongs is the first E-RNTI, and the first E-RNTI may be an additional primary E-RNTI, or may be a group. E-RNTI (group E-RNTI).
  • the first E-RNTI is common, and the base station configures the same first E-RNTI for all UEs in the group to which the UE belongs.
  • the first E-RNTI controls all UEs in a group, thereby implementing the group activation or deactivation process, reducing the use of the E-AGCH, improving the use efficiency of the downlink code resources, and avoiding Downstream throughput is limited.
  • the receiving module 1301 is further configured to: after the sending module 1302 sends the E-RNTI configured by the base station to the UE to the UE, receive the updated first E-RNTI sent by the base station, and send the first E sent by the receiving base station. - notification of changes to RNTI;
  • the sending module 1302 is further configured to send the updated first E-RNTI received by the receiving module 1301 to the UE.
  • the E-RNTI configured by the receiving module 1301 for the UE includes a primary E-RNTI and a secondary E-RNTI.
  • the E-RNTI allocated by the base station to the group to which the UE belongs is the secondary E-RNTI, and the secondary E-RNTI is common, and the base station configures the same secondary E-RNTI for all UEs in the group to which the UE belongs. In this way, all the UEs in a group can be controlled by the secondary E-RNTI, thereby implementing the activation or deactivation process of the group, reducing the use of the E-AGCH, and improving the use of the downlink code resources. Efficiency, avoiding limited downlink throughput.
  • the receiving module 1301 is further configured to: after the sending module 1302 sends the E-RNTI configured by the base station to the UE to the UE, receive the updated secondary E-RNTI sent by the base station, and perform the secondary E-RNTI sent by the receiving base station. Notice of change;
  • the sending module 1302 is further configured to send the updated secondary E-RNTI received by the receiving module 1301 to the UE.
  • the E-RNTI configured by the receiving module 1301 for the UE includes the primary E-RNTI; or the E-RNTI configured by the receiving module 1301 for the UE includes the primary E-RNTI.
  • auxiliary E-RNTL configured by the receiving module 1301 for the UE includes the primary E-RNTI.
  • the receiving module 1301 is further configured to: after the sending module 1302 sends the uplink enhanced dedicated channel configuration information of the UE to the base station, receive the HARQ process information that the base station allocates for the UE.
  • the HARQ process information may be configuration information of a HARQ process that allows the UE to send data.
  • the foregoing RNC may further include: a configuration module 1303;
  • the receiving module 1301 is further configured to: after receiving the HARQ process information that the base station allocates for the UE, receive process state information of the UE sent by the base station;
  • the configuration module 1303 is configured to initially configure or reconfigure a process state of the UE according to the process state information received by the receiving module 1301.
  • the receiving module 1301 is further configured to: after the sending module 1302 sends the E-RNTI configured by the base station to the UE to the UE, receive the process state information of the UE sent by the base station, and receive the process of the UE. After the status information, the RNC can configure or not configure the UE's process status.
  • the process state information of the UE may be one or a combination of the HARQ process activation or deactivation state information of the UE, the load information of the HARQ process, the high and low speed indication message, and the indication authorization message.
  • the sending module 1302 is further configured to: after the uplink enhanced dedicated channel configuration information of the UE is sent to the base station, the receiving module 1301 sends an indication message to the base station before receiving the E-RNTI configured by the base station, and the foregoing A message configuration indicating that the base station performs radio link establishment. That is, the base station may configure the E-RNTL for the UE after receiving the indication message sent by the RNC.
  • the sending module 1302 sends the uplink enhanced dedicated channel configuration information of the UE to the base station, and then the receiving module 1301 receives the base station sent by the base station.
  • An E-RNTI configured for the UE, and the E-RNTI configured by the base station for the UE is sent by the sending module 1302 to the UE, where the E-RNTI configured by the base station for the UE may include the group allocated by the base station to the UE.
  • E-RNTI it is possible to control all UEs in a group according to the E-RNTI allocated by the base station to the group to which the UE belongs, thereby implementing the operation of the group activation or deactivation process, and reducing the E -
  • AGCH improves the efficiency of downlink code resources and avoids limited downlink throughput.
  • FIG. 14 is a schematic structural diagram of still another embodiment of a user equipment according to the present invention.
  • the UE in this embodiment may implement the process of the embodiment shown in FIG. 1 of the present invention.
  • the UE may include: a transmitter 1401. And a processor 1403;
  • the transmitter 1401 is configured to report, to the RNC, the capability of the UE to support an uplink enhanced dedicated channel.
  • the receiver 1402 is configured to receive a configuration message sent by the RNC, where the configuration message carries an E-RNTI, where the E-RNTI carried in the configuration message may be included in a group to which the UE belongs. E-RNTI;
  • the processor 1403 is configured to: the E-RNTI carried by the configuration message received by the receiver 1402 monitors the first channel, and activates or deactivates the HARQ process according to the absolute authorization received in the first channel.
  • the first channel may be an E-AGCH or a public E-AGCH (common
  • E-AGCH or non-serving E-AGCH (non-serving E-AGCH).
  • the foregoing absolute authorization includes an activation or deactivation indication of the HARQ process of the UE, and the activation indication of the HARQ process of the UE is a specific authorization value.
  • the E-RNTI carried in the configuration message received by the receiver 1402 includes the first E-RNTI and the primary E-RNTI; or the E-RNTI carried in the configuration message received by the receiver 1402 includes the first An E-RNTI, a primary E-RNTI, and a secondary E-RNTI.
  • the E-RNTI allocated to the group to which the UE belongs is the first E-RNTI, and the first E-RNTI may be an additional primary E-RNTI, or may be a group.
  • E-RNTI group E-RNTI
  • the first E-RNTI is common, and the base station configures the same first E-RNTI for all UEs in the group to which the UE belongs.
  • all the UEs in a group can be controlled by using the first E-RNTI, thereby implementing the operation of the group activation or deactivation process, reducing the use of the E-AGCH, and improving the downlink code resources. Use efficiency to avoid limited downlink throughput.
  • the processor 1403 is further configured to: when the absolute authorization identified as the first E-RNTI or the primary E-RNTI is received in the first channel, before the activation or deactivation of the HARQ process, determining that the identifier is ⁇ The type of absolute authorization of the E-RNTI or the primary E-RNTI is the primary authorization.
  • the processor 1403 is configured to activate or deactivate the HARQ process according to the absolute authorization received in the first channel:
  • the processor 1403 is configured to: when the identifier of the absolute authorization received in the first channel is the first E-RNTI, and the absolute authorization value of the absolute authorization is a deactivation command, if the absolute authorization range of the foregoing absolute authorization is The HARQ process corresponding to the HARQ process number corresponding to the current TTI is deactivated for each HARQ process and the TTI configured for 2 ms. Alternatively, if the absolute authorization range of the above absolute authorization is all HARQ processes, the TTI is configured for 2 milliseconds, and the secondary TTI is configured.
  • E-RNTI then deactivate all HARQ processes; or, if the absolute authorization range of the above absolute authorization is all HARQ processes and configured secondary E-RNTIs, all HARQ processes are activated, Set the service authorization to store the second authorization value and set the primary authorization validity to false.
  • the processor 1403 is configured to activate or deactivate the HARQ process according to the absolute authorization received in the first channel:
  • the processor 1403 is configured to: when the identifier of the absolute authorization received in the first channel is the first E-RNTI, and the absolute authorization value of the absolute authorization is not a deactivation command, if the absolute authorization range of the foregoing absolute authorization is For each HARQ process, the HARQ process corresponding to the HARQ process number corresponding to the current TTI is activated; or, if the absolute authorization range of the above absolute authorization is all HARQ processes, all HARQ processes are activated.
  • the processor 1403 is configured to activate or deactivate the HARQ process according to the absolute authorization received in the first channel:
  • the processor 1403 is configured to: when the identifier of the absolute authorization received in the first channel is the first E-RNTI, and the absolute authorization value of the absolute authorization is not the deactivation command, activate the HARQ process number corresponding to the current TTI. Corresponding HARQ process, and deactivate all HARQ processes.
  • the processor 1403 is further configured to: when the identifier of the absolute authorization received in the first channel is the first E-RNTI, and the absolute authorization value of the foregoing absolute authorization is not deactivated When the command is made, the primary authorization validity is set to true.
  • the processor 1403 is further configured to: when the identifier of the absolute authorization received in the first channel is the first E-RNTI, and the absolute authorization value of the absolute authorization is not the deactivation command. If the above-mentioned absolute authorized timer is in an untriggered state, the timer is started, or if the above-mentioned absolutely authorized timer is in a triggered state, the timer is reset.
  • the processor 1403 is further configured to: when the identifier of the absolute authorization received in the first channel is the first E-RNTI, the primary E-RNTI, or the primary authorization validity is set to false And if the absolute authorization value of the absolute authorization is not a deactivation command, if the absolute authorization value of the absolute authorization is not a zero authorization command, setting the service authorization to a maximum value of the absolute authorization value and the minimum configuration service authorization value; Or, if the absolute authorization value of the above absolute authorization is zero authorization command, the service authorization is set to zero authorization.
  • the transmitter 1401 is specifically used to increase the uplink to the RNC.
  • the ability to receive an absolute grant identified as the first E-RNTI is supported during strong dedicated channel operation.
  • the configuration message received by the receiver 1402 is carried.
  • the E-RNTI includes the primary E-RNTI and the secondary E-RNTI.
  • the E-RNTI allocated by the base station to the group to which the UE belongs is the secondary E-RNTI
  • the secondary E-RNTI is common
  • the base station is the UE.
  • All UEs in the group are configured with the same secondary E-RNTI. In this way, all the UEs in a group can be controlled by the secondary E-RNTI, thereby implementing the operation of the group activation or deactivation process, reducing the use of the E-AGCH, and improving the use of the downlink code resources. Efficiency, avoiding limited downlink throughput.
  • the processor 1403 is configured to: activate or deactivate the HARQ process according to the absolute authorization received in the first channel: the processor 1403, specifically, when receiving in the first channel
  • the absolute authorization identifier is the secondary E-RNTI, and when the absolute authorization value of the above absolute authorization is the deactivation command, if the absolute authorization scope of the above absolute authorization is per HARQ process and the configured 2 millisecond TTI, the current TTI is deactivated.
  • the processor 1403 is configured to activate or deactivate the HARQ process according to the absolute authorization received in the first channel:
  • the processor 1403 is configured to: when the identifier of the absolute authorization received in the first channel is a secondary E-RNTI, and the absolute authorization value of the absolute authorization is not a deactivation command, if the absolute authorization range of the absolute authorization is The HARQ process activates the HARQ process corresponding to the HARQ process number corresponding to the current TTI. Alternatively, if the absolute authorization range of the above absolute authorization is all HARQ processes, all HARQ processes are activated.
  • the processor 1403 is configured to activate or deactivate the HARQ process according to the absolute authorization received in the first channel:
  • the processor 1403 is specifically configured to: when the identifier of the absolute authorization received in the first channel is
  • the HARQ process corresponding to the HARQ process number corresponding to the current TTI is activated, and the HARQ process number corresponding to the current TTI is deactivated in all the HARQ processes.
  • the processor 1403 further uses When the identifier of the absolute authorization received in the first channel is the secondary E-RNTI, and the absolute authorization value of the above absolute authorization is not the deactivation command, if the above absolute authorization value is not the zero authorization command, the service authorization is set to The maximum value of the absolute authorization value and the minimum configuration service authorization value; or, if the above absolute authorization value is a zero authorization command, the service authorization is set to zero authorization.
  • the processor 1403 is further configured to: when the identifier of the absolute authorization received in the first channel is a secondary E-RNTI, and the absolute authorization value of the foregoing absolute authorization is not a deactivation command. If the above-mentioned absolute authorized timer is in the untriggered state, the timer is started; or, if the above-mentioned absolutely authorized timer is in the triggered state, the timer is reset.
  • the E-RNTI carried in the configuration message received by the receiver 1402 includes the primary E-RNTI; or the E-RNTI carried in the configuration message received by the receiver 1402 includes the primary E-RNTI and the auxiliary E-RNTI;
  • the processor 1403 is further configured to determine, after receiving the absolute authorization that is the primary E-RNTI in the first channel, before the activation or deactivation of the HARQ process, determining the absolute authorization that is the primary E-RNTI.
  • the type is the primary authorization.
  • the processor 1403 is configured to activate or deactivate the HARQ process according to the absolute authorization received in the first channel:
  • the processor 1403 is configured to: when the identifier of the absolute authorization received in the first channel is the primary E-RNTI, and the absolute authorization value of the absolute authorization is a deactivation command, if the absolute authorization range of the absolute authorization is The HARQ process and the configured 2 ms TTI are used to deactivate the HARQ process corresponding to the HARQ process number corresponding to the current TTI; or, if the absolute authorization range of the above absolute authorization is all HARQ processes, 2 ms TTI configured, and no auxiliary E configured - RNTI, deactivate all HARQ processes; or, if the absolute authorization range of the above absolute authorization is all HARQ processes and configured secondary E-RNTIs, activate all HARQ processes, set the service authorization to store the second authorization value, and Set the master authorization validity to false.
  • the processor 1403 is configured to activate or deactivate the HARQ process according to the absolute authorization received in the first channel:
  • the processor 1403 is configured to: when the identifier of the absolute authorization received in the first channel is the primary E-RNTI, and the absolute authorization value of the absolute authorization is not a deactivation command, if the foregoing If the absolute authorization range for the authorization is the per-HARQ process, the HARQ process corresponding to the HARQ process number corresponding to the current TTI is deactivated. Alternatively, if the absolute authorization range of the above absolute authorization is all HARQ processes, all HARQ processes are activated.
  • the processor 1403 is further configured to: when the absolute authorization identifier received in the first channel is the primary E-RNTI, and the absolute authorization value of the foregoing absolute authorization is not When the command is deactivated, the primary authorization validity is set to true.
  • the processor 1403 is further configured to: when the absolute authorization identifier received in the first channel is the primary E-RNTI, and the absolute authorization value of the absolute authorization is not the deactivation command.
  • the above timer is started if the above-mentioned absolute authorized timer is in an untriggered state; or, if the above-mentioned absolutely authorized timer is in a triggered state, the timer is reset.
  • the processor 1403 is further configured to: when the identifier of the absolute authorization received in the first channel is the primary E-RNTI or the primary authorization validity is set to false, and the foregoing absolute authorization If the absolute authorization value is not the deactivation command, if the absolute authorization value of the above absolute authorization is not a zero authorization command, the service authorization is set to the maximum value of the absolute authorization value and the minimum configuration service authorization value; or, if the above absolute If the authorized absolute authorization value is zero authorization command, the service authorization is set to zero authorization.
  • the transmitter 1401 reports the capability of the UE to support the uplink enhanced dedicated channel to the RNC
  • the receiver 1402 receives the configuration message sent by the RNC
  • the processor 1403 monitors the first channel by using the E-RNTI carried in the configuration message.
  • the E-RNTI carried in the configuration message may include an E-RNTI allocated for the group to which the UE belongs; then, the processor 1403 activates or deactivates the HARQ process according to the absolute authorization received in the first channel. Therefore, the E-RNTI allocated for the group to which the UE belongs according to the foregoing configuration message can be used to control all the UEs in a group, thereby implementing the operation of the group activation or deactivation process, and reducing the E-AGCH.
  • the use of the downlink code resource is improved, and the downlink throughput is limited.
  • FIG. 15 is a schematic structural diagram of another embodiment of a base station according to the present invention.
  • the base station in this embodiment may implement the process of the embodiment shown in FIG. 2 of the present invention.
  • the base station may include: a receiver 1501. 1502 and a transmitter 1503;
  • the receiver 1501 is configured to receive an uplink enhanced dedicated channel configuration signal of the UE sent by the RNC. Interest rate
  • the processor 1502 is configured to: after the receiver 1501 receives the uplink enhanced dedicated channel configuration information of the UE, configure an E-RNTI for the UE; where the E-RNTI configured by the processor 1502 for the UE may include the processor 1502 being the UE.
  • the transmitter 1503 is configured to send the E-RNTI configured by the processor 1502 to the UE to the RNC, and send the absolute authorization of the E-RNTI identified as the configuration to the UE by using the first channel.
  • the first channel may be an E-AGCH, a common E-AGCH (common E-AGCH), or a non-serving E-AGCH (non-serving E-AGCH).
  • the processor 1502 is specifically configured to configure a first E-RNTI and a primary E-RNTI for the UE; or, configure a first E-RNTI, a primary E-RNTI, and a secondary E- for the UE.
  • RNTI the E-RNTI allocated by the processor 1502 to the group to which the UE belongs is the first E-RNTI, and the first E-RNTI may be the additional primary E-RNTK additional Primary E-RNTI. It can be a group E-RNTI (group E-RNTI).
  • group E-RNTI group E-RNTI
  • the first E-RNTI is common, and the processor 1502 configures the same first E-RNTI for all UEs in the group to which the UE belongs.
  • all UEs in a group can be controlled by the first E-RNTI, thereby implementing the operation of the group activation or deactivation process, reducing the use of the E-AGCH, and improving the downlink code resources. Use efficiency to avoid limited downlink throughput.
  • the absolute authorization that the transmitter 1503 uses to send the E-RNTI that is configured to be configured to the UE by using the first channel may be: the transmitter 1503, specifically configured to: when the current control requirement is separately controlled, pass the first channel. Sending an absolute authorization to the UE as the primary E-RNTI; or, when the current control requirement is group control, transmitting the absolute authorization identified as the first E-RNTI to the UE through the first channel.
  • the transmitter 1503 is further configured to send, after the base station needs to change the first E-RNTI of the UE, after transmitting the absolute authorization that is configured as the configured E-RNTI, to the RNC, send the updated first E-RNTI to the RNC. And notifying the RNC to perform the change of the first E-RNTI, so that the RNC sends the updated first E-RNTI to the UE.
  • the processor 1502 is specifically configured to configure a primary E-RNTI and a secondary E-RNTI for the UE.
  • the processor 1502 allocates the E-RNTI to the group to which the UE belongs to the secondary E-RNTI, where the secondary E-RNTI is common, and the processor 1502 configures the same auxiliary for all the UEs in the group to which the UE belongs.
  • E-RNTI In this way, you can pass the auxiliary
  • the E-RNTI controls all UEs in a group, which can implement the group activation or deactivation process, reduce the use of E-AGCH, improve the efficiency of downlink code resources, and avoid downlink throughput. Limited.
  • the absolute authorization that the transmitter 1503 uses to send the E-RNTI that is configured to be configured to the UE by using the first channel may be: the transmitter 1503, specifically configured to: when the current control requirement is separately controlled, pass the first channel.
  • the absolute authorization of the primary E-RNTI is sent to the UE; or, when the current control requirement is the group control, the absolute authorization identified as the secondary E-RNTI is sent to the UE through the first channel.
  • the transmitter 1503 is further configured to send, after the base station needs to change the secondary E-RNTI of the UE, after transmitting the absolute authorization identified as the configured E-RNTI to the UE, and send the updated secondary E-RNTI to the RNC, and The RNC is notified to perform the change of the secondary E-RNTI, so that the RNC transmits the updated secondary E-RNTI to the UE.
  • the processor 1502 is specifically configured to configure a primary E-RNTI for the UE, or configure a primary E-RNTI and a secondary E-RNTI for the UE.
  • the transmitter 1503 is further configured to: after the processor 1502 configures the E-RNTI for the UE, send the HARQ process information allocated by the processor 1502 to the UE to the RNC.
  • the HARQ process information may be configuration information of a HARQ process that allows the UE to send data.
  • the transmitter 1503 is further configured to send the process state information of the UE to the RNC after the HARQ process information allocated by the processor 1502 for the UE is sent to the RNC, so that the RNC initially configures or reconfigures the UE according to the process state information. Process status.
  • the transmitter 1503 is further configured to send the process state information of the UE to the RNC after transmitting the absolute authorization identified as the configured E-RNTI to the UE, and then, after receiving the process state information of the UE, the RNC
  • the process state of the UE can be configured or not configured.
  • the process state information of the UE may be one or a combination of the HARQ process activation or deactivation state information of the UE, the load information of the HARQ process, the high and low speed indication message, and the indication authorization message.
  • the receiver 1501 is further configured to: after receiving the uplink enhanced dedicated channel configuration information of the UE that is sent by the RNC, before receiving the E-RNTI, the processor 1502 receives an indication message sent by the RNC, where the indication message is used to indicate The base station performs message configuration for radio link establishment. That is, the base station may receive the indication message sent by the RNC, and then Configure the E-RNTI for the UE.
  • the processor 1502 is configured to configure an E-RNTI for the UE according to the current control reference information, where the current control reference information includes: a rate of the UE, a data block of the UE, and a process that is allocated by the UE. No., one or a combination of the packet information corresponding to the foregoing UE and the current cell process usage.
  • the processor 1502 configures the E-RNTI for the UE; then the transmitter 1503 sends the E-RNTI configured for the UE to the RNC.
  • the E-RNTI configured by the base station for the UE is sent by the RNC to the UE, where the E-RNTI configured by the base station for the UE may include an E-RNTI allocated by the base station to the group to which the UE belongs.
  • all the UEs in a group can be controlled according to the E-RNTI allocated by the base station to the group to which the UE belongs, and the operation of the group activation or deactivation process can be implemented, thereby reducing the use of the E-AGCH.
  • the efficiency of using downlink code resources is improved, and downlink throughput is limited.
  • FIG. 16 is a schematic structural diagram of another embodiment of a radio network controller according to the present invention.
  • the RNC in this embodiment may implement the process of the embodiment shown in FIG. 3 of the present invention.
  • the RNC may include: a receiver 1601. And a transmitter 1602;
  • the receiver 1601 is configured to receive, by the UE, the capability of the UE to support the uplink enhanced dedicated channel, and after the transmitter 1602 sends the uplink enhanced dedicated channel configuration information of the UE to the base station, the receiving base station sends the E configured by the base station to the UE.
  • An RNTI where the E-RNTI configured by the base station for the UE may include an E-RNTI allocated by the base station to the group to which the UE belongs;
  • the transmitter 1602 is configured to: send the uplink enhanced dedicated channel configuration information of the UE to the base station; and after the receiver 1601 receives the E-RNTI configured by the base station and configured by the base station to be the UE, configure the E-RNTI configured by the base station as the UE.
  • the UE is sent to the UE to listen to the first channel with the configured E-RNTI and activate or deactivate the HARQ process according to the absolute grant received in the first channel.
  • the transmitter 1602 sends the uplink enhanced dedicated channel configuration information of the UE to the base station.
  • the uplink enhanced dedicated channel configuration information of the UE includes information such as a frame offset of the uplink enhanced dedicated channel supported by the UE.
  • the first channel may be an E-AGCH or a common E-AGCH (common E-AGCH) or non-serving E-AGCH (non-serving E-AGCH).
  • the E-RNTI configured by the receiver 1601 for the UE includes the first E-RNTI and the primary E-RNTI; or the E-RNTI configured by the receiver 1601 is configured by the UE for the UE.
  • the first E-RNTI, the primary E-RNTI, and the secondary E-RNTI are included.
  • the E-RNTI allocated by the base station to the group to which the UE belongs is the first E-RNTI, and the first E-RNTI may be an additional primary E-RNTI, or may be a group. E-RNTI (group E-RNTI).
  • the first E-RNTI is common, and the base station configures the same first E-RNTI for all UEs in the group to which the UE belongs. In this way, all the UEs in a group can be controlled by using the first E-RNTI, thereby implementing the operation of the group activation or deactivation process, reducing the use of the E-AGCH, and improving the downlink code resources. Use efficiency to avoid limited downlink throughput.
  • the receiver 1601 is further configured to: after the transmitter 1602 sends the E-RNTI configured by the base station to the UE to the UE, receive the updated first E-RNTI sent by the base station, and send the first E sent by the receiving base station. - notification of changes to RNTI;
  • the E-RNTI configured by the receiver 1601 for the UE includes a primary E-RNTI and a secondary E-RNTI.
  • the E-RNTI allocated by the base station to the group to which the UE belongs is a secondary E-RNTI, and the secondary E-RNTI is common, and the base station configures the same secondary E-RNTI for all UEs in the group to which the UE belongs. In this way, all the UEs in a group can be controlled by the secondary E-RNTI, thereby implementing the operation of the group activation or deactivation process, reducing the use of the E-AGCH, and improving the use of the downlink code resources. Efficiency, avoiding limited downlink throughput.
  • the receiver 1601 is further configured to: after the transmitter 1602 sends the E-RNTI configured by the base station to the UE to the UE, receive the updated secondary E-RNTI sent by the base station, and perform the secondary E-RNTI sent by the receiving base station. Notice of change;
  • the transmitter 1602 is further configured to send the updated secondary E-RNTI received by the receiver 1601 to the UE.
  • the E-RNTI configured by the receiver 1601 for the UE includes the primary E-RNTI; or the base station received by the receiver 1601 is configured for the UE.
  • the E-RNTI includes a primary E-RNTI and a secondary E-RNTI.
  • the receiver 1601 is further configured to: after the transmitter 1602 sends the uplink enhanced dedicated channel configuration information of the UE to the base station, receive the HARQ process information that the base station allocates for the UE.
  • the HARQ process information may be configuration information of a HARQ process that allows the UE to send data.
  • the foregoing RNC may further include: a processor 1603;
  • the receiver 1601 is further configured to: after receiving the HARQ process information that the base station allocates for the UE, receive process state information of the UE sent by the base station;
  • the processor 1603 is configured to initially configure or reconfigure a process state of the UE according to the process state information received by the receiver 1601.
  • the receiver 1601 is further configured to: after the transmitter 1602 sends the E-RNTI configured by the base station to the UE to the UE, receive the process state information of the UE sent by the base station, and receive the process of the UE. After the status information, the RNC can configure or not configure the UE's process status.
  • the process state information of the UE may be one or a combination of the HARQ process activation or deactivation state information of the UE, the load information of the HARQ process, the high and low speed indication message, and the indication authorization message.
  • the transmitter 1602 is further configured to: after the uplink enhanced dedicated channel configuration information of the UE is sent to the base station, the receiver 1601 sends an indication message to the base station before the base station sends the E-RNTI configured by the base station to the UE, where the indication message is used by the A message configuration indicating that the base station performs radio link establishment. That is, the base station may configure the E-RNTI for the UE after receiving the indication message sent by the RNC.
  • the transmitter 1602 sends the uplink enhanced dedicated channel configuration information of the UE to the base station, and then the receiver 1601 receives the base station sent by the base station.
  • An E-RNTI configured for the UE, and the E-RNTI configured by the base station for the UE is sent by the transmitter 1602 to the UE, where the E-RNTI configured by the base station for the UE may include the group allocated by the base station to the UE.
  • the E-RNTI can be implemented to control all UEs in a group according to the E-RNTI allocated by the base station to the group to which the UE belongs, thereby implementing the operation of the group activation or deactivation process, and reducing the E -
  • the use of AGCH improves the efficiency of the use of downlink code resources. Avoiding downstream throughput is limited.
  • modules in the apparatus in the embodiments may be distributed in the apparatus of the embodiment according to the embodiment description, or the corresponding changes may be located in one or more apparatuses different from the embodiment.
  • the modules of the above embodiments may be combined into one module, or may be further split into a plurality of sub-modules.

Landscapes

  • Engineering & Computer Science (AREA)
  • Computer Networks & Wireless Communication (AREA)
  • Signal Processing (AREA)
  • Mobile Radio Communication Systems (AREA)

Abstract

本发明提供一种组调度授权的方法、用户设备和无线网络控制器,该组调度授权的方法包括:UE向RNC上报该UE支持上行增强专用信道的能力;接收RNC发送的配置消息,该配置消息携带E-RNTI;该配置消息携带的E-RNTI包括为上述UE所属的群组分配的E-RNTI;UE釆用上述配置消息携带的E-RNTI监听第一信道,并根据UE在第一信道中接收到的绝对授权激活或去激活HARQ进程。本发明可以实现根据上述配置消息携带的为上述UE所属的群组分配的E-RNTI对一个群组下的所有UE进行控制,进而可以实现群组的激活或去激活进程的操作,减少了E-AGCH的使用,提高了下行码资源的使用效率,避免了下行吞吐量受限。

Description

组调度授权的方法、 用户设备和无线网络控制器 技术领域
本发明涉及通信技术领域, 尤其涉及一种组调度授权的方法、 用户设 备和无线网络控制器。 背景技术
随着通信技术的飞速发展, 宽带码分多址 (Wideband Code Division Multiple Access; 以下简称: WCDMA )作为第三代移动通信系统的主流 技术之一, 在全球范围内得到了广泛的研究和应用。 目前 WCDMA 已经 有第 99版本(Release99; 以下简称: R99 ) 、 第 4版本( Release4; 以下 简称: R4 ) -第 11版本(Releasel l ; 以下简称: R11 ) 等多个版本。
WCDMA R6版本中, 对上行链路针对分组业务进行优化和演进, 引 入了高速上行分组接入(High Speed Uplink Packet Access; 以下简称: HSUPA )技术。 与 HSDPA技术类似, HSUPA釆用了混合自动重复请求 ( Hybrid Automatic Repeat Request; 以下简称: HARQ ) ,基于基站( Node B ) 的快速调度, 和 2ms传输时间间隔 ( Transmission Time Interval; 以下 简称: TTI ) 短帧传输。 HSUPA 使得单小区最大上行数据吞吐率达到 5.76Mbit/s, 大大增强了 WCDMA上行链路的数据业务承载能力和频谱利 用率。
在 WCDMA R11版本中,增强小区前向接入信道( Cell-Forward Access Channel; 以下简称: CELL-FACH ) 的特性里引入了 CELL-FACH用户与 小区专用信道( Cell-Dedicated; 以下简称: CELL-DCH )用户时间对齐( TTI alignment between CELL-FACH UEs and CELL-DCH UEs )技术。 此技术的 主要思想是将 CELL-FACH用户与 CELL-DCH用户的数据块上行子帧对 齐传输, 可以减少 CELL-DCH用户和 CELL-FACH用户之间的干扰 , 从 而提高小区吞吐量。 实际上, 此项技术就是时分调度 ( Time-Division Multiple Scheduling; 以下简称: TDM scheduling )在 CELL-FACH下的实 现和应用。 目前的通用移动通信系统 ( Universal Mobile Telecommunications System; 以下简称: UMTS ) 网络中, 智能手机的市场渗透率越来越高, 网络数据处理量急速上升, 上行的干扰问题也逐渐呈现出来。 由于 UMTS 是个自干扰系统, 上行干扰主要来自于用户间的相互干扰, 而通过仿真和 理论分析证明, 对于上行传输进行 TDM调度对于用户间干扰有艮大的抑 制作用。 所以 TDM调度在未来就不仅仅应用于 CELL-FACH状态, 还会 扩展到 CELL-DCH状态。
现有技术中, 增强专用信道绝对授权信道 ( Enhanced Dedicated Channel Absolute Grant Channel; 以下简称: E-AGCH )携带的信息比特包 括 5比特的绝对授权值和 1比特的绝对授权范围。
当釆用 2ms增强专用信道 ( Enhanced Dedicated Channel; 以下简称: E-DCH ) TTI 时, 绝对授权 ( Absolute Grant; 以下简称: AG ) 从接收到 生效的定时设置如下: 用户设备( User Equipment; 以下简称: UE )在第 i个系统帧编号 ( System Frame Number; 以下简称: SFN ) 中 E-AGCH帧 的第 j个子帧上首先收到的 E-DCH控制信息 (即 AG ) , 是对应第 i+s个 SFN 中 E-DCH 专用物理数据信道 ( E-DCH Dedicated Physical Data Channel; 以下简称: E-DPDCH ) 帧的第 t个子帧。
现在协议中支持每个 UE配置两个 E-DCH无线网络临时标识( E-DCH Radio Network Temporary Identifier; 以下简称: E-RNTI ) , 主 E-RNTI ( Primary E-RNTI; 以下简称: P-E-RNTI )是每个用户独有的标识 , 理论 上通过配置相同的辅 E-RNTI ( Secondary E-RNTI; 以下简称: S-E-RNTI ) 可以实现 1对多的控制, 但是 S-E-RNTI不能用于进程的去激活, 也不能 用于每 HARQ ( per HARQ ) 进程的激活。
在实现本发明的过程中, 发明人发现: 现有技术不能进行群组的激活 和 /或去激活进程的操作, 在每 HARQ ( per HARQ ) 调度系统中 AG的使 用量过大, 造成下行码资源消耗严重, 从而可能影响下行吞吐量。 发明内容
本发明提供一种组调度授权的方法、 用户设备和无线网络控制器, 以 实现提高下行码资源的使用效率, 避免下行吞吐量受限。 本发明第一方面提供一种组调度授权的方法, 包括:
用户设备向无线网络控制器上报所述用户设备支持上行增强专用信 道的能力;
所述用户设备接收所述无线网络控制器发送的配置消息, 所述配置消 息携带增强专用信道无线网络临时标识 E-RNTI;
所述用户设备釆用所述配置消息携带的 E-RNTI监听第一信道, 并根 据所述用户设备在所述第一信道中接收到的绝对授权激活或去激活混合 自动重传请求 HARQ进程。
结合第一方面, 在第一方面的第一种可能的实现方式中, 所述配置消 息携带的 E-RNTI包括第一 E-RNTI和主 E-RNTI; 所述为所述用户设备所 属的群组分配的 E-RNTI为所述第一 E-RNTI。
结合第一方面的第一种可能的实现方式, 在第一方面的第二种可能的 实现方式中, 所述根据所述用户设备在所述第一信道中接收到的绝对授权 激活或去激活混合自动重传请求 HARQ进程之前,还包括: 当所述用户设 备在所述第一信道中接收到标识为第 ― E-RNTI或主 E-RNTI的绝对授权 时 , 所述用户设备确定标识为第一 E-RNTI或主 E-RNTI的绝对授权的类 型为主授权。
结合第一方面的第一种可能的实现方式或者第一方面的第二种可能 的实现方式, 在第一方面的第三种可能的实现方式中, 所述根据所述用户 设备在所述第一信道中接收到的绝对授权激活或去激活混合自动重传请 求 HARQ进程包括:如果所述用户设备在所述第一信道中接收到的绝对授 权的标识为第一 E-RNTI, 并且所述绝对授权的绝对授权值为去激活命令, 则当所述绝对授权的绝对授权范围为每 HARQ进程和已配置 2毫秒传输时 间间隔 TTI时 , 所述用户设备去激活当前 TTI对应的 HARQ进程号所对 应的 HARQ进程; 或者, 当所述绝对授权的绝对授权范围为所有 HARQ 进程、 已配置 2毫秒 TTI并且未配置辅 E-RNTI时, 所述用户设备去激活 所有 HARQ进程; 或者, 当所述绝对授权的绝对授权范围为所有 HARQ 进程和已配置辅 E-RNTI时, 所述用户设备激活所有 HARQ进程, 将服务 授权设置为储存第二授权值 , 并将主授权有效性设置为假。
结合第一方面的第一种可能的实现方式或者第一方面的第二种可能 的实现方式, 在第一方面的第四种可能的实现方式中, 所述根据所述用户 设备在所述第一信道中接收到的绝对授权激活或去激活混合自动重传请 求 HARQ进程包括:如果所述用户设备在所述第一信道中接收到的绝对授 权的标识为第一 E-RNTI, 并且所述绝对授权的绝对授权值不是去激活命 令, 则当所述绝对授权的绝对授权范围为每 HARQ进程时, 所述用户设备 激活当前 TTI对应的 HARQ进程号所对应的 HARQ进程; 或者, 当所述 绝对授权的绝对授权范围为所有 HARQ 进程时, 所述用户设备激活所有 HARQ进程。
结合第一方面的第一种可能的实现方式或者第一方面的第二种可能 的实现方式, 在第一方面的第五种可能的实现方式中, 所述根据所述用户 设备在所述第一信道中接收到的绝对授权激活或去激活混合自动重传请 求 HARQ进程包括:如果所述用户设备在所述第一信道中接收到的绝对授 权的标识为第一 E-RNTI, 并且所述绝对授权的绝对授权值不是去激活命 令, 则所述用户设备激活当前 TTI对应的 HARQ进程号所对应的 HARQ 进程 , 并去激活所有 HARQ进程中除当前 TTI对应的 HARQ进程号所对 应的 HARQ进程之外的 HARQ进程。
结合第一方面的第一种可能的实现方式或者第一方面的第二种可能 的实现方式, 在第一方面的第六种可能的实现方式中, 所述方法还包括: 如果所述用户设备在所述第一信道中接收到的绝对授权的标识为第一 E-RNTI, 并且所述绝对授权的绝对授权值不是去激活命令, 则所述用户设 备将主授权有效性设置为真;
或者, 如果所述用户设备在所述第一信道中接收到的绝对授权的标识 为第一 E-RNTI, 并且所述绝对授权的绝对授权值不是去激活命令, 则当 所述绝对授权的定时器处于未触发状态时, 所述用户设备启动所述定时 器, 或者, 当所述绝对授权的定时器处于触发状态时, 所述用户设备重置 所述定时器。
结合第一方面的第一种可能的实现方式或者第一方面的第二种可能 的实现方式, 在第一方面的第七种可能的实现方式中, 所述方法还包括: 如果所述用户设备在所述第一信道中接收到的绝对授权的标识为第一 Ε-RNTL· 主 E-RNTI或者主授权有效性设置为假, 并且所述绝对授权的绝 对授权值不是去激活命令, 则当所述绝对授权的绝对授权值不是零授权命 令时, 所述用户设备将服务授权设置为所述绝对授权值与最小配置服务授 权值中的最大值; 或者, 当所述绝对授权的绝对授权值为零授权命令时, 所述用户设备将服务授权设置为零授权。
结合第一方面的第一种可能的实现方式〜第七种可能的实现方式中的 任意一种实现方式, 在第一方面的第八种可能的实现方式中, 所述用户设 备向无线网络控制器上报所述用户设备支持上行增强专用信道的能力包 括: 所述用户设备向所述无线网络控制器上报所述用户设备在上行增强专 用信道操作期间支持接收标识为第一 E-RNTI的绝对授权的能力。
结合第一方面, 在第一方面的第九种可能的实现方式中, 所述配置消 息携带的 E-RNTI包括主 E-RNTI和辅 E-RNTI; 所述为所述用户设备所属 的群组分配的 E-RNTI为所述辅 E-RNTI。
结合第一方面的第九种可能的实现方式, 在第一方面的第十种可能的 实现方式中, 所述根据所述用户设备在所述第一信道中接收到的绝对授权 激活或去激活混合自动重传请求 HARQ进程包括:如果所述用户设备在所 述第一信道中接收到的绝对授权的标识为辅 E-RNTI, 并且所述绝对授权 的绝对授权值为去激活命令, 则当所述绝对授权的绝对授权范围为每 HARQ进程和已配置 2毫秒 TTI时 ,所述用户设备去激活当前 TTI对应的 HARQ进程号所对应的 HARQ进程; 或者, 当所述绝对授权的绝对授权 范围为所有 HARQ进程和已配置 2毫秒 TTI时, 所述用户设备去激活所 有 HARQ进程。
结合第一方面的第九种可能的实现方式, 在第一方面的第十一种可能 的实现方式中, 所述根据所述用户设备在所述第一信道中接收到的绝对授 权激活或去激活混合自动重传请求 HARQ进程包括:如果所述用户设备在 所述第一信道中接收到的绝对授权的标识为辅 E-RNTI, 并且所述绝对授 权的绝对授权值不是去激活命令, 则当所述绝对授权的绝对授权范围为每 HARQ进程时, 所述用户设备激活当前 TTI对应的 HARQ进程号所对应 的 HARQ进程; 或者, 当所述绝对授权的绝对授权范围为所有 HARQ进 程时, 所述用户设备激活所有 HARQ进程。
结合第一方面的第九种可能的实现方式, 在第一方面的第十二种可能 的实现方式中, 所述根据所述用户设备在所述第一信道中接收到的绝对授 权激活或去激活混合自动重传请求 HARQ进程包括:如果所述用户设备在 所述第一信道中接收到的绝对授权的标识为辅 E-RNTI, 并且所述绝对授 权的绝对授权值不是去激活命令, 则所述用户设备激活当前 TTI 对应的 HARQ进程号所对应的 HARQ进程 , 并去激活所有 HARQ进程中除当前 结合第一方面的第九种可能的实现方式, 在第一方面的第十三种可能 的实现方式中, 所述方法还包括: 如果所述用户设备在所述第一信道中接 收到的绝对授权的标识为辅 E-RNTI, 并且所述绝对授权的绝对授权值不 是去激活命令, 则当所述绝对授权值不是零授权命令时, 所述用户设备将 服务授权设置为所述绝对授权值与最小配置服务授权值中的最大值; 或 者, 当所述绝对授权值是零授权命令时, 所述用户设备将服务授权设置为 零授权。
结合第一方面的第九种可能的实现方式, 在第一方面的第十四种可能 的实现方式中, 所述方法还包括: 如果所述用户设备在所述第一信道中接 收到的绝对授权的标识为辅 E-RNTI, 并且所述绝对授权的绝对授权值不 是去激活命令, 则当所述绝对授权的定时器处于未触发状态时, 所述用户 设备启动所述定时器; 或者, 当所述绝对授权的定时器处于触发状态时, 所述用户设备重置所述定时器。
结合第一方面, 在第一方面的第十五种可能的实现方式中, 所述配置 消息携带的 E-RNTI包括主 E-RNTI; 或者, 所述配置消息携带的 E-RNTI 包括主 E-RNTI和辅 E-RNTI。
结合第一方面的第十五种可能的实现方式, 在第一方面的第十六种可 能的实现方式中, 所述根据所述用户设备在所述第一信道中接收到的绝对 授权激活或去激活混合自动重传请求 HARQ进程之前,还包括: 当所述用 户设备在所述第一信道中接收到标识为主 E-RNTI的绝对授权时, 所述用 户设备确定标识为主 E-RNTI的绝对授权的类型为主授权。
结合第一方面的第十五种可能的实现方式或者第一方面的第十六种 可能的实现方式, 在第一方面的第十七种可能的实现方式中, 所述根据所 述用户设备在所述第一信道中接收到的绝对授权激活或去激活混合自动 重传请求 HARQ进程包括:如果所述用户设备在所述第一信道中接收到的 绝对授权的标识为主 E-RNTI, 并且所述绝对授权的绝对授权值为去激活 命令,则当所述绝对授权的绝对授权范围为每 HARQ进程和已配置 2毫秒 TTI 时, 所述用户设备去激活当前 TTI 对应的 HARQ 进程号所对应的 HARQ进程; 或者, 当所述绝对授权的绝对授权范围为所有 HARQ进程、 已配置 2 毫秒 TTI和没有配置辅 E-RNTI 时, 所述用户设备去激活所有 HARQ进程; 或者, 当所述绝对授权的绝对授权范围为所有 HARQ进程 和已配置辅 E-RNTI时, 所述用户设备激活所有 HARQ进程, 将服务授权 设置为储存第二授权值, 并将主授权有效性设置为假。
结合第一方面的第十五种可能的实现方式或者第一方面的第十六种 可能的实现方式, 在第一方面的第十八种可能的实现方式中, 所述根据所 述用户设备在所述第一信道中接收到的绝对授权激活或去激活混合自动 重传请求 HARQ进程包括:如果所述用户设备在所述第一信道中接收到的 绝对授权的标识为主 E-RNTI, 并且所述绝对授权的绝对授权值不是去激 活命令, 则当所述绝对授权的绝对授权范围为每 HARQ进程时, 所述用户 设备去激活当前 TTI对应的 HARQ进程号所对应的 HARQ进程; 或者, 当所述绝对授权的绝对授权范围为所有 HARQ进程时 ,所述用户设备激活 所有 HARQ进程。
结合第一方面的第十五种可能的实现方式或者第一方面的第十六种 可能的实现方式, 在第一方面的第十九种可能的实现方式中, 所述方法还 包括: 如果所述用户设备在所述第一信道中接收到的绝对授权的标识为主 E-RNTI, 并且所述绝对授权的绝对授权值不是去激活命令, 则所述用户设 备将主授权有效性设置为真。
结合第一方面的第十五种可能的实现方式或者第一方面的第十六种 可能的实现方式, 在第一方面的第二十种可能的实现方式中, 所述方法还 包括: 如果所述用户设备在所述第一信道中接收到的绝对授权的标识为主 E-RNTI, 并且所述绝对授权的绝对授权值不是去激活命令, 则当所述绝对 授权的定时器处于未触发状态时, 所述用户设备启动所述定时器, 或者, 当所述绝对授权的定时器处于触发状态时, 所述用户设备重置所述定时 器。 结合第一方面的第十五种可能的实现方式或者第一方面的第十六种 可能的实现方式, 在第一方面的第二十一种可能的实现方式中, 所述方法 还包括: 如果所述用户设备在所述第一信道中接收到的绝对授权的标识为 主 E-RNTI或者主授权有效性设置为假, 并且所述绝对授权的绝对授权值 不是去激活命令, 则当所述绝对授权的绝对授权值不是零授权命令时, 所 述用户设备将服务授权设置为所述绝对授权值与最小配置服务授权值中 的最大值; 或者, 当所述绝对授权的绝对授权值为零授权命令时, 所述用 户设备将服务授权设置为零授权。
结合第一方面, 或者结合第一方面的第一种可能的实现方式〜第一方 面的第二十一种可能的实现方式中的任意一种实现方式, 在第一方面的第 二十二种可能的实现方式中, 所述第一信道包括增强专用信道绝对授权信 道 E-AGCH、 公共 E-AGCH或非服务小区 E-AGCH。
本发明第二方面提供一种组调度授权的方法, 包括:
基站接收到无线网络控制器发送的用户设备的上行增强专用信道配 置信息之后, 为所述用户设备配置增强专用信道无线网络临时标识 E-RNTI;
所述基站将为所述用户设备配置的 E-RNTI发送给无线网络控制器, 以便所述无线网络控制器将所述基站为所述用户设备配置的 E-RNTI发送 给所述用户设备;
所述基站通过第一信道向所述用户设备发送标识为配置的 E-RNTI的 绝对授权。
结合第二方面, 在第二方面的第一种可能的实现方式中, 所述为所述 用户设备配置增强专用信道无线网络临时标识 E-RNTI包括: 所述基站为 所述用户设备配置第一 E-RNTI和主 E-RNTI;所述基站为所述用户设备所 属的群组分配的 E-RNTI为所述第一 E-RNTI。
结合第二方面的第一种可能的实现方式, 在第二方面的第二种可能的 实现方式中, 所述基站通过第一信道向所述用户设备发送标识为配置的 E-RNTI 的绝对授权包括: 如果当前控制需求为单独控制, 则所述基站通 过第一信道向所述用户设备发送标识为所述主 E-RNTI的绝对授权;或者, 如果当前控制需求为群组控制, 则所述基站通过第一信道向所述用户设备 发送标识为所述第一 E-RNTI的绝对授权。
结合第二方面的第一种可能的实现方式或者第二方面的第二种可能 的实现方式, 在第二方面的第三种可能的实现方式中, 所述基站通过第一 信道向所述用户设备发送标识为配置的 E-RNTI的绝对授权之后,还包括: 如果所述基站需要改变所述用户设备的第一 E-RNTI, 则所述基站向所述 无线网络控制器发送更新后的第一 E-RNTI, 并通知所述无线网络控制器 进行第一 E-RNTI的变更, 以便所述无线网络控制器将所述更新后的第一 E-RNTI发送给所述用户设备。
结合第二方面, 在第二方面的第四种可能的实现方式中, 所述为所述 用户设备配置增强专用信道无线网络临时标识 E-RNTI包括: 所述基站为 所述用户设备配置主 E-RNTI和辅 E-RNTI;所述基站为所述用户设备所属 的群组分配的 E-RNTI为所述辅 E-RNTI。
结合第二方面的第四种可能的实现方式, 在第二方面的第五种可能的 实现方式中, 所述基站通过第一信道向所述用户设备发送标识为配置的 E-RNTI 的绝对授权包括: 如果当前控制需求为单独控制, 则所述基站通 过第一信道向所述用户设备发送标识为所述主 E-RNTI的绝对授权;或者, 如果当前控制需求为群组控制, 则所述基站通过第一信道向所述用户设备 发送标识为所述辅 E-RNTI的绝对授权。
结合第二方面的第四种可能的实现方式或者第二方面的第五种可能 的实现方式, 在第二方面的第六种可能的实现方式中, 所述基站通过第一 信道向所述用户设备发送标识为配置的 E-RNTI的绝对授权之后,还包括: 如果所述基站需要改变所述用户设备的辅 E-RNTI, 则所述基站向所述无 线网络控制器发送更新后的辅 E-RNTI, 并通知所述无线网络控制器进行 辅 E-RNTI 的变更, 以便所述无线网络控制器将所述更新后的辅 E-RNTI 发送给所述用户设备。
结合第二方面, 在第二方面的第七种可能的实现方式中, 所述为所述 用户设备配置增强专用信道无线网络临时标识 E-RNTI包括: 所述基站为 所述用户设备配置主 E-RNTI; 或者, 所述基站为所述用户设备配置主 E-RNTI和辅 E-RNTL
结合第二方面的第七种可能的实现方式, 在第二方面的第八种可能的 实现方式中, 所述为所述用户设备配置增强专用信道无线网络临时标识
E-RNTI之后, 还包括: 所述基站将为所述用户设备分配的 HARQ进程信 息发送给所述无线网络控制器。
结合第二方面的第八种可能的实现方式, 在第二方面的第九种可能的 实现方式中,所述基站将为所述用户设备分配的 HARQ进程信息发送给所 述无线网络控制器之后, 还包括: 所述基站将所述用户设备的进程状态信 息发送给所述无线网络控制器, 以便所述无线网络控制器根据所述进程状 态信息初始配置或者重配置所述用户设备的进程状态。
结合第二方面的第七种可能的实现方式〜第九种可能的实现方式中的 任意一种实现方式, 在第二方面的第十种可能的实现方式中, 所述基站通 过第一信道向所述用户设备发送标识为配置的 E-RNTI的绝对授权之后, 还包括: 所述基站向所述无线网络控制器发送所述用户设备的进程状态信 息。
结合第二方面的第九种可能的实现方式或者第二方面的第十种可能 的实现方式, 在第二方面的第十一种可能的实现方式中, 所述进程状态信 息包括所述用户设备的混合自动重传请求 HARQ 进程激活或去激活状态 信息、 HARQ进程的负载信息、 高低速指示消息和指示授权消息之一或组 合。
结合第二方面, 或者结合第二方面的第一种可能的实现方式〜第十一 种可能的实现方式中的任意一种实现方式, 在第二方面的第十二种可能的 实现方式中, 所述基站接收到无线网络控制器发送的用户设备的上行增强 专用信道配置信息之后, 所述为所述用户设备配置增强专用信道无线网络 临时标识 E-RNTI之前, 还包括: 所述基站接收所述无线网络控制器发送 的指示消息, 所述指示消息用于指示所述基站进行无线链路建立的消息配 置。
结合第二方面, 或者结合第二方面的第一种可能的实现方式〜第十一 种可能的实现方式中的任意一种实现方式, 在第二方面的第十三种可能的 实现方式中, 所述为所述用户设备配置增强专用信道无线网络临时标识 E-RNTI 包括: 所述基站根据当前控制参考信息为所述用户设备配置 E-RNTI; 所述当前控制参考信息包括: 所述用户设备的速率、 所述用户设 备的数据块、 所述用户设备被分配的进程号、 所述用户设备对应的分组信 息和当前小区进程使用情况之一或组合。
结合第二方面, 或者结合第二方面的第一种可能的实现方式〜第十三 种可能的实现方式中的任意一种实现方式, 在第二方面的第十四种可能的 实现方式中,所述绝对授权包括所述用户设备的 HARQ进程的激活或去激 活指示, 所述用户设备的 HARQ进程的激活指示为具体的授权值。
本发明第三方面提供一种组调度授权的方法, 包括:
无线网络控制器接收用户设备上报的所述用户设备支持上行增强专 用信道的能力;
所述无线网络控制器将所述用户设备的上行增强专用信道配置信息 发送给基站;
所述无线网络控制器接收所述基站发送的所述基站为所述用户设备 配置的 E-RNTI,并将所述基站为所述用户设备配置的 E-RNTI发送给所述 用户设备, 以便所述用户设备釆用所述配置的 E-RNTI监听第一信道, 并 根据在所述第一信道中接收到的绝对授权激活或去激活混合自动重传请 求 HARQ进程。
结合第三方面, 在第三方面的第一种可能的实现方式中, 所述基站为 所述用户设备配置的 E-RNTI包括第一 E-RNTI和主 E-RNTI; 所述基站为 所述用户设备所属的群组分配的 E-RNTI为所述第一 E-RNTI。
结合第三方面的第一种可能的实现方式, 在第三方面的第二种可能的 实现方式中, 所述将所述基站为所述用户设备配置的 E-RNTI发送给所述 用户设备之后, 还包括: 所述无线网络控制器接收所述基站发送的更新后 的第一 E-RNTI, 以及接收所述基站发送的进行第一 E-RNTI 的变更的通 知; 所述无线网络控制器将所述更新后的第一 E-RNTI发送给所述用户设 备。
结合第三方面, 在第三方面的第三种可能的实现方式中, 所述基站为 所述用户设备配置的 E-RNTI包括主 E-RNTI和辅 E-RNTI; 所述基站为所 述用户设备所属的群组分配的 E-RNTI为所述辅 E-RNTI。
结合第三方面的第三种可能的实现方式, 在第三方面的第四种可能的 实现方式中, 所述将所述基站为所述用户设备配置的 E-RNTI发送给所述 用户设备之后, 还包括: 所述无线网络控制器接收所述基站发送的更新后 的辅 E-RNTI, 以及接收所述基站发送的进行辅 E-RNTI的变更的通知; 所 述无线网络控制器将所述更新后的辅 E-RNTI发送给所述用户设备。
结合第三方面, 在第三方面的第五种可能的实现方式中, 所述基站为 所述用户设备配置的 E-RNTI包括主 E-RNTI; 或者, 所述基站为所述用户 设备配置的 E-RNTI包括主 E-RNTI和辅 E-RNTL
结合第三方面的第五种可能的实现方式, 在第三方面的第六种可能的 实现方式中, 所述无线网络控制器将所述用户设备的上行增强专用信道配 置信息发送给基站之后, 还包括: 所述无线网络控制器接收所述基站为所 述用户设备分配的 HARQ进程信息。
结合第三方面的第六种可能的实现方式, 在第三方面的第七种可能的 实现方式中, 所述无线网络控制器接收所述基站为所述用户设备分配的 HARQ进程信息之后, 还包括: 所述无线网络控制器接收所述基站发送的 所述用户设备的进程状态信息; 所述无线网络控制器根据所述进程状态信 息初始配置或者重配置所述用户设备的进程状态信息。
结合第三方面的第五种可能的实现方式〜第七种可能的实现方式中的 任意一种实现方式, 在第三方面的第八种可能的实现方式中, 所述将所述 基站为所述用户设备配置的 E-RNTI发送给所述用户设备之后, 还包括: 所述无线网络控制器接收所述基站发送的所述用户设备的进程状态信息。
结合第三方面, 或者结合第三方面的第一种可能的实现方式〜第八种 可能的实现方式中的任意一种实现方式, 在第三方面的第九种可能的实现 方式中, 所述无线网络控制器将所述用户设备的上行增强专用信道配置信 息发送给基站之后, 所述无线网络控制器接收所述基站发送的所述基站为 所述用户设备配置的 E-RNTI之前, 还包括: 所述无线网络控制器向所述 基站发送指示消息, 所述指示消息用于指示所述基站进行无线链路建立的 消息配置。
本发明第四方面提供一种用户设备, 包括:
上报模块, 用于向无线网络控制器上报所述用户设备支持上行增强专 用信道的能力;
接收模块, 用于接收所述无线网络控制器发送的配置消息, 所述配置 消息携带增强专用信道无线网络临时标识 E-RNTI;
监听模块, 用于釆用所述接收模块接收的配置消息携带的 E-RNTI监 听第一信道;
激活 /去激活模块,用于根据所述监听模块在所述第一信道中接收到的 绝对授权激活或去激活混合自动重传请求 HARQ进程。
结合第四方面, 在第四方面的第一种可能的实现方式中, 所述接收模 块接收的配置消息携带的 E-RNTI包括第 ― E-RNTI和主 E-RNTI; 所述为 所述用户设备所属的群组分配的 E-RNTI为所述第一 E-RNTI。
结合第四方面的第一种可能的实现方式, 在第四方面的第二种可能的 实现方式中, 所述用户设备还包括: 第一确定模块;
所述第一确定模块,用于在所述激活 /去激活模块激活或去激活 HARQ 进程之前, 当所述监听模块在所述第一信道中接收到标识为第一 E-RNTI 或主 E-RNTI的绝对授权时 ,确定标识为第一 E-RNTI或主 E-RNTI的绝对 授权的类型为主授权。
结合第四方面的第一种可能的实现方式或者第四方面的第二种可能 的实现方式,在第四方面的第三种可能的实现方式中, 所述激活 /去激活模 块, 具体用于当所述监听模块在所述第一信道中接收到的绝对授权的标识 为第一 E-RNTI, 并且所述绝对授权的绝对授权值为去激活命令时, 如果 所述绝对授权的绝对授权范围为每 HARQ进程和已配置 2毫秒传输时间间 隔 TTI, 则去激活当前 TTI对应的 HARQ进程号所对应的 HARQ进程; 或者, 如果所述绝对授权的绝对授权范围为所有 HARQ 进程、 已配置 2 毫秒 TTI并且未配置辅 E-RNTI, 则去激活所有 HARQ进程; 或者, 如果 所述绝对授权的绝对授权范围为所有 HARQ进程和已配置辅 E-RNTI , 则 激活所有 HARQ进程,将服务授权设置为储存第二授权值, 并将主授权有 效性设置为假。
结合第四方面的第一种可能的实现方式或者第四方面的第二种可能 的实现方式,在第四方面的第四种可能的实现方式中, 所述激活 /去激活模 块, 具体用于当所述监听模块在所述第一信道中接收到的绝对授权的标识 为第一 E-RNTI, 并且所述绝对授权的绝对授权值不是去激活命令时, 如 果所述绝对授权的绝对授权范围为每 HARQ进程, 则激活当前 TTI对应 的 HARQ进程号所对应的 HARQ进程; 或者, 如果所述绝对授权的绝对 授权范围为所有 HARQ进程, 则激活所有 HARQ进程。
结合第四方面的第一种可能的实现方式或者第四方面的第二种可能 的实现方式,在第四方面的第五种可能的实现方式中, 所述激活 /去激活模 块, 具体用于当所述监听模块在所述第一信道中接收到的绝对授权的标识 为第一 E-RNTI, 并且所述绝对授权的绝对授权值不是去激活命令时, 激 活当前 TTI对应的 HARQ进程号所对应的 HARQ 进程, 并去激活所有 HARQ进程中除当前 TTI对应的 HARQ进程号所对应的 HARQ进程之外 的 HARQ进程。
结合第四方面的第一种可能的实现方式或者第四方面的第二种可能 的实现方式, 在第四方面的第六种可能的实现方式中, 所述用户设备还包 括: 第一设置模块;
所述第一设置模块, 用于当所述监听模块在所述第一信道中接收到的 绝对授权的标识为第一 E-RNTI, 并且所述绝对授权的绝对授权值不是去 激活命令时, 将主授权有效性设置为真;
或者,
所述第一设置模块, 用于当所述监听模块在所述第一信道中接收到的 绝对授权的标识为第一 E-RNTI, 并且所述绝对授权的绝对授权值不是去 激活命令时, 如果所述绝对授权的定时器处于未触发状态, 则启动所述定 时器, 或者, 如果所述绝对授权的定时器处于触发状态, 则重置所述定时
所述第一设置模块, 用于当所述监听模块在所述第一信道中接收到的 绝对授权的标识为第一 E-RNTI、 主 E-RNTI或者主授权有效性设置为假, 并且所述绝对授权的绝对授权值不是去激活命令时, 如果所述绝对授权的 绝对授权值不是零授权命令, 则将服务授权设置为所述绝对授权值与最小 配置服务授权值中的最大值; 或者, 如果所述绝对授权的绝对授权值为零 授权命令, 则将服务授权设置为零授权。
结合第四方面的第一种可能的实现方式〜第四方面的第六种可能的实 现方式中的任意一种实现方式, 在第四方面的第七种可能的实现方式中, 所述上报模块, 具体用于向所述无线网络控制器上报所述用户设备在上行 增强专用信道操作期间支持接收标识为第一 E-RNTI的绝对授权的能力。
结合第四方面, 在第四方面的第八种可能的实现方式中, 所述接收模 块接收的配置消息携带的 E-RNTI包括主 E-RNTI和辅 E-RNTI; 所述为所 述用户设备所属的群组分配的 E-RNTI为所述辅 E-RNTI。
结合第四方面的第八种可能的实现方式, 在第四方面的第九种可能的 实现方式中, 所述激活 /去激活模块, 具体用于当所述监听模块在所述第一 信道中接收到的绝对授权的标识为辅 E-RNTI , 并且所述绝对授权的绝对 授权值为去激活命令时 ,如果所述绝对授权的绝对授权范围为每 HARQ进 程和已配置 2毫秒 TTI,则去激活当前 TTI对应的 HARQ进程号所对应的 HARQ进程; 或者, 如果所述绝对授权的绝对授权范围为所有 HARQ进 程和已配置 2毫秒 TTI , 则去激活所有 HARQ进程。
结合第四方面的第八种可能的实现方式, 在第四方面的第十种可能的 实现方式中, 所述激活 /去激活模块, 具体用于当所述监听模块在所述第一 信道中接收到的绝对授权的标识为辅 E-RNTI, 并且所述绝对授权的绝对 授权值不是去激活命令时, 如果所述绝对授权的绝对授权范围为每 HARQ 进程 , 则激活当前 TTI对应的 HARQ进程号所对应的 HARQ进程; 或者, 如果所述绝对授权的绝对授权范围为所有 HARQ进程,则激活所有 HARQ 进程。
结合第四方面的第八种可能的实现方式, 在第四方面的第十一种可能 的实现方式中, 所述激活 /去激活模块, 具体用于当所述监听模块在所述第 一信道中接收到的绝对授权的标识为辅 E-RNTI , 并且所述绝对授权的绝 对授权值不是去激活命令时, 激活当前 TTI对应的 HARQ进程号所对应 的 HARQ进程 , 并去激活所有 HARQ进程中除当前 TTI对应的 HARQ进 程号所对应的 HARQ进程之外的 HARQ进程。
结合第四方面的第八种可能的实现方式, 在第四方面的第十二种可能 的实现方式中, 所述用户设备还包括: 第二设置模块;
所述第二设置模块, 用于当所述监听模块在所述第一信道中接收到的 绝对授权的标识为辅 E-RNTI, 并且所述绝对授权的绝对授权值不是去激 活命令时, 如果所述绝对授权值不是零授权命令, 则将服务授权设置为所 述绝对授权值与最小配置服务授权值中的最大值; 或者, 如果所述绝对授 权值是零授权命令, 则将服务授权设置为零授权;
或者,
所述第二设置模块, 用于当所述监听模块在所述第一信道中接收到的 绝对授权的标识为辅 E-RNTI, 并且所述绝对授权的绝对授权值不是去激 活命令时, 如果所述绝对授权的定时器处于未触发状态, 则启动所述定时 器; 或者, 如果所述绝对授权的定时器处于触发状态, 则重置所述定时器。
结合第四方面, 在第四方面的第十三种可能的实现方式中, 所述接收 模块接收的配置消息携带的 E-RNTI包括主 E-RNTI; 或者, 所述接收模块 接收的配置消息携带的 E-RNTI包括主 E-RNTI和辅 E-RNTI;
结合第四方面的第十三种可能的实现方式, 在第四方面的第十四种可 能的实现方式中, 所述用户设备还包括: 第二确定模块;
所述第二确定模块,用于在所述激活 /去激活模块激活或去激活 HARQ 进程之前, 当所述监听模块在所述第一信道中接收到标识为主 E-RNTI的 绝对授权时, 确定标识为主 E-RNTI的绝对授权的类型为主授权。
结合第四方面的第十三种可能的实现方式或者第四方面的第十四种 可能的实现方式, 在第四方面的第十五种可能的实现方式中, 所述激活 / 去激活模块, 具体用于当所述监听模块在所述第一信道中接收到的绝对授 权的标识为主 E-RNTI, 并且所述绝对授权的绝对授权值为去激活命令时, 如果所述绝对授权的绝对授权范围为每 HARQ进程和已配置 2毫秒 ΤΉ, 则去激活当前 TTI对应的 HARQ进程号所对应的 HARQ进程; 或者, 如 果所述绝对授权的绝对授权范围为所有 HARQ进程、 已配置 2 毫秒 ΤΉ 和没有配置辅 E-RNTI, 则去激活所有 HARQ进程; 或者, 如果所述绝对 授权的绝对授权范围为所有 HARQ进程和已配置辅 E-RNTI , 则激活所有 HARQ进程, 将服务授权设置为储存第二授权值, 并将主授权有效性设置 为假。
结合第四方面的第十三种可能的实现方式或者第四方面的第十四种 可能的实现方式, 在第四方面的第十六种可能的实现方式中, 所述激活 / 去激活模块, 具体用于当所述监听模块在所述第一信道中接收到的绝对授 权的标识为主 E-RNTI, 并且所述绝对授权的绝对授权值不是去激活命令 时, 如果所述绝对授权的绝对授权范围为每 HARQ 进程, 则去激活当前 TTI对应的 HARQ进程号所对应的 HARQ进程; 或者, 如果所述绝对授 权的绝对授权范围为所有 HARQ进程, 则激活所有 HARQ进程。
结合第四方面的第十三种可能的实现方式或者第四方面的第十四种 可能的实现方式, 在第四方面的第十七种可能的实现方式中, 所述用户设 备还包括: 第三设置模块;
所述第三设置模块, 用于当所述监听模块在所述第一信道中接收到的 绝对授权的标识为主 E-RNTI, 并且所述绝对授权的绝对授权值不是去激 活命令时, 将主授权有效性设置为真;
或者,
所述第三设置模块, 用于当所述监听模块在所述第一信道中接收到的 绝对授权的标识为主 E-RNTI, 并且所述绝对授权的绝对授权值不是去激 活命令时, 如果所述绝对授权的定时器处于未触发状态, 则启动所述定时 器, 或者, 如果所述绝对授权的定时器处于触发状态, 则重置所述定时器; 或者,
所述第三设置模块, 用于当所述监听模块在所述第一信道中接收到的 绝对授权的标识为主 E-RNTI或者主授权有效性设置为假, 并且所述绝对 授权的绝对授权值不是去激活命令时, 如果所述绝对授权的绝对授权值不 是零授权命令, 则将服务授权设置为所述绝对授权值与最小配置服务授权 值中的最大值; 或者, 如果所述绝对授权的绝对授权值为零授权命令, 则 将服务授权设置为零授权。
本发明第五方面提供一种基站, 包括:
接收模块, 用于接收无线网络控制器发送的用户设备的上行增强专用 信道配置信息;
配置模块, 用于在所述接收模块接收到所述用户设备的上行增强专用 信道配置信息之后, 为所述用户设备配置增强专用信道无线网络临时标识 E-RNTI;
发送模块, 用于将所述配置模块为所述用户设备配置的 E-RNTI发送 给无线网络控制器, 以及通过第一信道向所述用户设备发送标识为配置的 E-RNTI的绝对授权。 结合第五方面, 在第五方面的第一种可能的实现方式中, 所述配置模 块, 具体用于为所述用户设备配置第一 E-RNTI和主 E-RNTI; 所述配置模 块为所述用户设备所属的群组分配的 E-RNTI为所述第一 E-RNTI。
结合第五方面的第一种可能的实现方式, 在第五方面的第二种可能的 实现方式中, 所述发送模块用于通过第一信道向所述用户设备发送标识为 配置的 E-RNTI的绝对授权包括:
所述发送模块, 具体用于在当前控制需求为单独控制时, 通过第一信 道向所述用户设备发送标识为所述主 E-RNTI的绝对授权; 或者, 在当前 控制需求为群组控制时, 通过第一信道向所述用户设备发送标识为所述第 一 E-RNTI的绝对授权。
结合第五方面的第一种可能的实现方式或者第五方面的第二种可能 的实现方式, 在第五方面的第三种可能的实现方式中, 所述发送模块, 还 用于在向所述用户设备发送标识为配置的 E-RNTI的绝对授权之后, 当所 述基站需要改变所述用户设备的第一 E-RNTI时, 向所述无线网络控制器 发送更新后的第一 E-RNTI, 并通知所述无线网络控制器进行第一 E-RNTI 的变更, 以便所述无线网络控制器将所述更新后的第一 E-RNTI发送给所 述用户设备。
结合第五方面, 在第五方面的第四种可能的实现方式中, 所述配置模 块, 具体用于为所述用户设备配置主 E-RNTI和辅 E-RNTI; 所述配置模块 为所述用户设备所属的群组分配的 E-RNTI为所述辅 E-RNTI。
结合第五方面的第四种可能的实现方式, 在第五方面的第五种可能的 实现方式中, 所述发送模块用于通过第一信道向所述用户设备发送标识为 配置的 E-RNTI的绝对授权包括: 所述发送模块, 具体用于在当前控制需 求为单独控制时, 通过第一信道向所述用户设备发送标识为所述主 E-RNTI 的绝对授权; 或者, 在当前控制需求为群组控制时, 通过第一信 道向所述用户设备发送标识为所述辅 E-RNTI的绝对授权。
结合第五方面的第四种可能的实现方式或者第五方面的第五种可能 的实现方式, 在第五方面的第六种可能的实现方式中, 所述发送模块, 还 用于在向所述用户设备发送标识为配置的 E-RNTI的绝对授权之后, 当所 述基站需要改变所述用户设备的辅 E-RNTI时, 向所述无线网络控制器发 送更新后的辅 E-RNTI, 并通知所述无线网络控制器进行辅 E-RNTI 的变 更, 以便所述无线网络控制器将所述更新后的辅 E-RNTI发送给所述用户 设备。
结合第五方面, 在第五方面的第七种可能的实现方式中, 所述配置模 块, 具体用于为所述用户设备配置主 E-RNTI; 或者, 为所述用户设备配 置主 E-RNTI和辅 E-RNTL
结合第五方面的第七种可能的实现方式, 在第五方面的第八种可能的 实现方式中, 所述发送模块, 还用于在所述配置模块为所述用户设备配置 E-RNTI之后, 将所述配置模块为所述用户设备分配的 HARQ进程信息发 送给所述无线网络控制器。
结合第五方面的第八种可能的实现方式, 在第五方面的第九种可能的 实现方式中, 所述发送模块, 还用于在将所述配置模块为所述用户设备分 配的 HARQ进程信息发送给所述无线网络控制器之后,将所述用户设备的 进程状态信息发送给所述无线网络控制器, 以便所述无线网络控制器根据 所述进程状态信息初始配置或者重配置所述用户设备的进程状态。
结合第五方面的第七种可能的实现方式〜第五方面的第九种可能的实 现方式中的任意一种实现方式, 在第五方面的第十种可能的实现方式中, 所述发送模块, 还用于在向所述用户设备发送标识为配置的 E-RNTI的绝 对授权之后, 向所述无线网络控制器发送所述用户设备的进程状态信息。
结合第五方面, 或者结合第五方面的第一种可能的实现方式〜第五方 面的第十种可能的实现方式中的任意一种实现方式, 在第五方面的第十一 种可能的实现方式中, 所述接收模块, 还用于在接收到无线网络控制器发 送的用户设备的上行增强专用信道配置信息之后, 所述配置模块为所述用 户设备配置增强专用信道无线网络临时标识 E-RNTI之前, 接收所述无线 网络控制器发送的指示消息, 所述指示消息用于指示所述基站进行无线链 路建立的消息配置。
结合第五方面, 或者结合第五方面的第一种可能的实现方式〜第五方 面的第十种可能的实现方式中的任意一种实现方式, 在第五方面的第十二 种可能的实现方式中, 所述配置模块, 具体用于根据当前控制参考信息为 所述用户设备配置 E-RNTI; 所述当前控制参考信息包括: 所述用户设备 的速率、 所述用户设备的数据块、 所述用户设备被分配的进程号、 所述用 户设备对应的分组信息和当前小区进程使用情况之一或组合。
本发明第六方面提供一种无线网络控制器, 包括:
接收模块, 用于接收用户设备上报的所述用户设备支持上行增强专用 信道的能力; 以及在发送模块将所述用户设备的上行增强专用信道配置信 息发送给基站之后, 接收所述基站发送的所述基站为所述用户设备配置的 E-RNTI;
所述发送模块, 用于将所述用户设备的上行增强专用信道配置信息发 送给基站; 以及在所述接收模块接收所述基站发送的所述基站为所述用户 设备配置的 E-RNTI之后, 将所述基站为所述用户设备配置的 E-RNTI发 送给所述用户设备, 以便所述用户设备釆用所述配置的 E-RNTI监听第一 信道, 并根据在所述第一信道中接收到的绝对授权激活或去激活混合自动 重传请求 HARQ进程。
结合第六方面, 在第六方面的第一种可能的实现方式中, 所述接收模 块接收的所述基站为所述用户设备配置的 E-RNTI包括第一 E-RNTI和主 E-RNTI; 其中, 所述基站为所述用户设备所属的群组分配的 E-RNTI为所 述第一 E-RNTI。
结合第六方面的第一种可能的实现方式, 在第六方面的第二种可能的 实现方式中, 所述接收模块, 还用于在所述发送模块将所述基站为所述用 户设备配置的 E-RNTI发送给所述用户设备之后, 接收所述基站发送的更 新后的第一 E-RNTI,以及接收所述基站发送的进行第一 E-RNTI的变更的 通知;所述发送模块,还用于将所述接收模块接收的更新后的第一 E-RNTI 发送给所述用户设备。
结合第六方面, 在第六方面的第三种可能的实现方式中, 所述接收模 块接收的所述基站为所述用户设备配置的 E-RNTI 包括主 E-RNTI 和辅 E-RNTI; 其中, 所述基站为所述用户设备所属的群组分配的 E-RNTI为所 述辅 E-RNTL
结合第六方面的第三种可能的实现方式, 在第六方面的第四种可能的 实现方式中, 所述接收模块, 还用于在所述发送模块将所述基站为所述用 户设备配置的 E-RNTI发送给所述用户设备之后, 接收所述基站发送的更 新后的辅 E-RNTI, 以及接收所述基站发送的进行辅 E-RNTI 的变更的通 知; 所述发送模块, 还用于将所述接收模块接收的更新后的辅 E-RNTI发 送给所述用户设备。
结合第六方面, 在第六方面的第五种可能的实现方式中, 所述接收模 块接收的所述基站为所述用户设备配置的 E-RNTI包括主 E-RNTI; 或者, 所述接收模块接收的所述基站为所述用户设备配置的 E-RNTI 包括主 E-RNTI和辅 E-RNTL
结合第六方面的第五种可能的实现方式, 在第六方面的第六种可能的 实现方式中, 所述接收模块, 还用于在所述发送模块将所述用户设备的上 行增强专用信道配置信息发送给基站之后, 接收所述基站为所述用户设备 分配的 HARQ进程信息。
结合第六方面的第六种可能的实现方式, 在第六方面的第七种可能的 实现方式中, 所述无线网络控制器还包括: 配置模块;
所述接收模块, 还用于在接收所述基站为所述用户设备分配的 HARQ 进程信息之后, 接收所述基站发送的所述用户设备的进程状态信息;
所述配置模块, 用于根据所述接收模块接收的进程状态信息初始配置 或者重配置所述用户设备的进程状态。
结合第六方面的第五种可能的实现方式〜第六方面的第七种可能的实 现方式中的任意一种实现方式, 在第六方面的第八种可能的实现方式中, 所述接收模块, 还用于在所述发送模块将所述基站为所述用户设备配置的 E-RNTI 发送给所述用户设备之后, 接收所述基站发送的所述用户设备的 进程状态信息。
结合第六方面, 或者结合第六方面的第一种可能的实现方式〜第六方 面的第八种可能的实现方式中的任意一种实现方式, 在第六方面的第九种 可能的实现方式中, 所述发送模块, 还用于在将所述用户设备的上行增强 专用信道配置信息发送给基站之后, 所述接收模块接收所述基站发送的所 述基站为所述用户设备配置的 E-RNTI之前, 向所述基站发送指示消息, 所述指示消息用于指示所述基站进行无线链路建立的消息配置。
本发明第七方面提供一种用户设备, 包括:
发送器, 用于向无线网络控制器上报所述用户设备支持上行增强专用 信道的能力;
接收器, 用于接收所述无线网络控制器发送的配置消息, 所述配置消 息携带增强专用信道无线网络临时标识 E-RNTI;
处理器, 用于釆用所述接收器接收的配置消息携带的 E-RNTI监听第 一信道, 以及根据在所述第一信道中接收到的绝对授权激活或去激活混合 自动重传请求 HARQ进程。
结合第七方面, 在第七方面的第一种可能的实现方式中, 所述接收器 接收的配置消息携带的 E-RNTI包括第 ― E-RNTI和主 E-RNTI; 所述为所 述用户设备所属的群组分配的 E-RNTI为所述第一 E-RNTI。
结合第七方面的第一种可能的实现方式, 在第七方面的第二种可能的 实现方式中, 所述处理器, 还用于在激活或去激活 HARQ进程之前, 当在 所述第一信道中接收到标识为第一 E-RNTI或主 E-RNTI的绝对授权时, 确定标识为第 ― E-RNTI或主 E-RNTI的绝对授权的类型为主授权。
结合第七方面的第一种可能的实现方式或者第七方面的第二种可能 的实现方式, 在第七方面的第三种可能的实现方式中, 所述处理器用于根 据在所述第一信道中接收到的绝对授权激活或去激活混合自动重传请求 HARQ进程包括:
所述处理器, 具体用于当在所述第一信道中接收到的绝对授权的标识 为第一 E-RNTI, 并且所述绝对授权的绝对授权值为去激活命令时, 如果 所述绝对授权的绝对授权范围为每 HARQ进程和已配置 2毫秒传输时间间 隔 TTI, 则去激活当前 TTI对应的 HARQ进程号所对应的 HARQ进程; 或者, 如果所述绝对授权的绝对授权范围为所有 HARQ 进程、 已配置 2 毫秒 TTI并且未配置辅 E-RNTI, 则去激活所有 HARQ进程; 或者, 如果 所述绝对授权的绝对授权范围为所有 HARQ进程和已配置辅 E-RNTI , 则 激活所有 HARQ进程,将服务授权设置为储存第二授权值, 并将主授权有 效性设置为假。
结合第七方面的第一种可能的实现方式或者第七方面的第二种可能 的实现方式, 在第七方面的第四种可能的实现方式中, 所述处理器用于根 据在所述第一信道中接收到的绝对授权激活或去激活混合自动重传请求 HARQ进程包括: 所述处理器, 具体用于当在所述第一信道中接收到的绝对授权的标识 为第一 E-RNTI, 并且所述绝对授权的绝对授权值不是去激活命令时, 如 果所述绝对授权的绝对授权范围为每 HARQ进程, 则激活当前 TTI对应 的 HARQ进程号所对应的 HARQ进程; 或者, 如果所述绝对授权的绝对 授权范围为所有 HARQ进程, 则激活所有 HARQ进程。
结合第七方面的第一种可能的实现方式或者第七方面的第二种可能 的实现方式, 在第七方面的第五种可能的实现方式中, 所述处理器用于根 据在所述第一信道中接收到的绝对授权激活或去激活混合自动重传请求 HARQ进程包括:
所述处理器, 具体用于当在所述第一信道中接收到的绝对授权的标识 为第一 E-RNTI, 并且所述绝对授权的绝对授权值不是去激活命令时, 激 活当前 TTI对应的 HARQ进程号所对应的 HARQ 进程, 并去激活所有 HARQ进程中除当前 TTI对应的 HARQ进程号所对应的 HARQ进程之外 的 HARQ进程。
结合第七方面的第一种可能的实现方式或者第七方面的第二种可能 的实现方式, 在第七方面的第六种可能的实现方式中, 所述处理器, 还用 于当在所述第一信道中接收到的绝对授权的标识为第一 E-RNTI, 并且所 述绝对授权的绝对授权值不是去激活命令时, 将主授权有效性设置为真; 或者,
所述处理器, 还用于当在所述第一信道中接收到的绝对授权的标识为 第一 E-RNTI, 并且所述绝对授权的绝对授权值不是去激活命令时, 如果 所述绝对授权的定时器处于未触发状态, 则启动所述定时器, 或者, 如果 所述绝对授权的定时器处于触发状态, 则重置所述定时器。
结合第七方面的第一种可能的实现方式或者第七方面的第二种可能 的实现方式, 在第七方面的第七种可能的实现方式中, 所述处理器, 还用 于当在所述第一信道中接收到的绝对授权的标识为第一 E-RNTI、 主 E-RNTI 或者主授权有效性设置为假, 并且所述绝对授权的绝对授权值不 是去激活命令时, 如果所述绝对授权的绝对授权值不是零授权命令, 则将 服务授权设置为所述绝对授权值与最小配置服务授权值中的最大值; 或 者, 如果所述绝对授权的绝对授权值为零授权命令, 则将服务授权设置为 零授权。
结合第七方面的第一种可能的实现方式〜第七方面的第七种可能的实 现方式中的任意一种实现方式, 在第七方面的第八种可能的实现方式中, 所述发送器, 具体用于向所述无线网络控制器上报所述用户设备在上行增 强专用信道操作期间支持接收标识为第一 E-RNTI的绝对授权的能力。
结合第七方面, 在第七方面的第九种可能的实现方式中, 所述接收器 接收的配置消息携带的 E-RNTI包括主 E-RNTI和辅 E-RNTI; 所述为所述 用户设备所属的群组分配的 E-RNTI为所述辅 E-RNTI。
结合第七方面的第九种可能的实现方式, 在第七方面的第十种可能的 实现方式中, 所述处理器用于根据在所述第一信道中接收到的绝对授权激 活或去激活混合自动重传请求 HARQ进程包括:
所述处理器, 具体用于当在所述第一信道中接收到的绝对授权的标识 为辅 E-RNTI, 并且所述绝对授权的绝对授权值为去激活命令时, 如果所 述绝对授权的绝对授权范围为每 HARQ进程和已配置 2毫秒 TTI,则去激 活当前 TTI对应的 HARQ进程号所对应的 HARQ进程; 或者, 如果所述 绝对授权的绝对授权范围为所有 HARQ进程和已配置 2毫秒 TTI,则去激 活所有 HARQ进程。
结合第七方面的第九种可能的实现方式, 在第七方面的第十一种可能 的实现方式中, 所述处理器用于根据在所述第一信道中接收到的绝对授权 激活或去激活混合自动重传请求 HARQ进程包括:
所述处理器, 具体用于当在所述第一信道中接收到的绝对授权的标识 为辅 E-RNTI, 并且所述绝对授权的绝对授权值不是去激活命令时, 如果 所述绝对授权的绝对授权范围为每 HARQ进程, 则激活当前 TTI对应的 HARQ进程号所对应的 HARQ进程; 或者, 如果所述绝对授权的绝对授 权范围为所有 HARQ进程, 则激活所有 HARQ进程。
结合第七方面的第九种可能的实现方式, 在第七方面的第十二种可能 的实现方式中, 所述处理器用于根据在所述第一信道中接收到的绝对授权 激活或去激活混合自动重传请求 HARQ进程包括:
所述处理器, 具体用于当在所述第一信道中接收到的绝对授权的标识 为辅 E-RNTI, 并且所述绝对授权的绝对授权值不是去激活命令时, 激活 当前 TTI对应的 HARQ进程号所对应的 HARQ进程,并去激活所有 HARQ 进程。
结合第七方面的第九种可能的实现方式, 在第七方面的第十三种可能 的实现方式中, 所述处理器, 还用于当在所述第一信道中接收到的绝对授 权的标识为辅 E-RNTI, 并且所述绝对授权的绝对授权值不是去激活命令 时, 如果所述绝对授权值不是零授权命令, 则将服务授权设置为所述绝对 授权值与最小配置服务授权值中的最大值; 或者, 如果所述绝对授权值是 零授权命令, 则将服务授权设置为零授权。
结合第七方面的第九种可能的实现方式, 在第七方面的第十四种可能 的实现方式中, 所述处理器, 还用于当在所述第一信道中接收到的绝对授 权的标识为辅 E-RNTI, 并且所述绝对授权的绝对授权值不是去激活命令 时, 如果所述绝对授权的定时器处于未触发状态, 则启动所述定时器; 或 者, 如果所述绝对授权的定时器处于触发状态时, 则重置所述定时器。
结合第七方面, 在第七方面的第十五种可能的实现方式中, 所述接收 器接收的配置消息携带的 E-RNTI包括主 E-RNTI; 或者, 所述接收器接收 的配置消息携带的 E-RNTI包括主 E-RNTI和辅 E-RNTI。
结合第七方面的第十五种可能的实现方式, 在第七方面的第十六种可 能的实现方式中, 所述处理器, 还用于在激活或去激活 HARQ进程之前, 当在所述第一信道中接收到标识为主 E-RNTI的绝对授权时, 确定标识为 主 E-RNTI的绝对授权的类型为主授权。
结合第七方面的第十五种可能的实现方式或者第七方面的第十六种 可能的实现方式, 在第七方面的第十七种可能的实现方式中, 所述处理器 用于根据在所述第一信道中接收到的绝对授权激活或去激活混合自动重 传请求 HARQ进程包括:
所述处理器, 具体用于当在所述第一信道中接收到的绝对授权的标识 为主 E-RNTI, 并且所述绝对授权的绝对授权值为去激活命令时, 如果所 述绝对授权的绝对授权范围为每 HARQ进程和已配置 2毫秒 TTI,则去激 活当前 TTI对应的 HARQ进程号所对应的 HARQ进程; 或者, 如果所述 绝对授权的绝对授权范围为所有 HARQ进程、 已配置 2毫秒 TTI和没有 配置辅 E-RNTI, 则去激活所有 HARQ进程; 或者, 如果所述绝对授权的 绝对授权范围为所有 HARQ进程和已配置辅 E-RNTI , 则激活所有 HARQ 进程, 将服务授权设置为储存第二授权值, 并将主授权有效性设置为假。
结合第七方面的第十五种可能的实现方式或者第七方面的第十六种 可能的实现方式, 在第七方面的第十八种可能的实现方式中, 所述处理器 用于根据在所述第一信道中接收到的绝对授权激活或去激活混合自动重 传请求 HARQ进程包括:
所述处理器, 具体用于当在所述第一信道中接收到的绝对授权的标识 为主 E-RNTI, 并且所述绝对授权的绝对授权值不是去激活命令时, 如果 所述绝对授权的绝对授权范围为每 HARQ进程, 则去激活当前 TTI对应 的 HARQ进程号所对应的 HARQ进程; 或者, 如果所述绝对授权的绝对 授权范围为所有 HARQ进程, 则激活所有 HARQ进程。
结合第七方面的第十五种可能的实现方式或者第七方面的第十六种 可能的实现方式, 在第七方面的第十九种可能的实现方式中,
所述处理器, 还用于当在所述第一信道中接收到的绝对授权的标识为 主 E-RNTI, 并且所述绝对授权的绝对授权值不是去激活命令时, 将主授 权有效性设置为真;
或者,
所述处理器, 还用于当在所述第一信道中接收到的绝对授权的标识为 主 E-RNTI, 并且所述绝对授权的绝对授权值不是去激活命令时, 如果所 述绝对授权的定时器处于未触发状态, 则启动所述定时器; 或者, 如果所 述绝对授权的定时器处于触发状态, 则重置所述定时器。
结合第七方面的第十五种可能的实现方式或者第七方面的第十六种 可能的实现方式, 在第七方面的第二十种可能的实现方式中,
所述处理器, 还用于当在所述第一信道中接收到的绝对授权的标识为 主 E-RNTI或者主授权有效性设置为假, 并且所述绝对授权的绝对授权值 不是去激活命令时, 如果所述绝对授权的绝对授权值不是零授权命令, 则 将服务授权设置为所述绝对授权值与最小配置服务授权值中的最大值; 或 者, 如果所述绝对授权的绝对授权值为零授权命令, 则将服务授权设置为 零授权。 本发明第八方面提供一种基站, 包括:
接收器, 用于接收无线网络控制器发送的用户设备的上行增强专用信 道配置信息;
处理器, 用于在所述接收器接收到所述用户设备的上行增强专用信道 配置信息之后, 为所述用户设备配置增强专用信道无线网络临时标识 E-RNTI;
发送器, 用于将所述处理器为所述用户设备配置的 E-RNTI发送给无 线网络控制器, 以及通过第一信道向所述用户设备发送标识为配置的 E-RNTI的绝对授权。
结合第八方面,在第八方面的第一种可能的实现方式中,所述处理器, 具体用于为所述用户设备配置第一 E-RNTI和主 E-RNTI;所述处理器为所 述用户设备所属的群组分配的 E-RNTI为所述第一 E-RNTI。
结合第八方面的第一种可能的实现方式, 在第八方面的第二种可能的 实现方式中, 所述发送器用于通过第一信道向所述用户设备发送标识为配 置的 E-RNTI的绝对授权包括:
所述发送器, 具体用于在当前控制需求为单独控制时, 通过第一信道 向所述用户设备发送标识为所述主 E-RNTI的绝对授权; 或者, 在当前控 制需求为群组控制时, 通过第一信道向所述用户设备发送标识为所述第 ― E-RNTI的绝对授权。
结合第八方面的第一种可能的实现方式或者第八方面的第二种可能 的实现方式, 在第八方面的第三种可能的实现方式中, 所述发送器, 还用 于在向所述用户设备发送标识为配置的 E-RNTI的绝对授权之后, 当所述 基站需要改变所述用户设备的第一 E-RNTI时, 向所述无线网络控制器发 送更新后的第一 E-RNTI, 并通知所述无线网络控制器进行第一 E-RNTI 的变更, 以便所述无线网络控制器将所述更新后的第一 E-RNTI发送给所 述用户设备。
结合第八方面,在第八方面的第四种可能的实现方式中,所述处理器, 具体用于为所述用户设备配置主 E-RNTI和辅 E-RNTI;所述处理器为所述 用户设备所属的群组分配的 E-RNTI为所述辅 E-RNTI。
结合第八方面的第四种可能的实现方式, 在第八方面的第五种可能的 实现方式中, 所述发送器用于通过第一信道向所述用户设备发送标识为配 置的 E-RNTI的绝对授权包括:
所述发送器, 具体用于在当前控制需求为单独控制时, 通过第一信道 向所述用户设备发送标识为所述主 E-RNTI的绝对授权; 或者, 在当前控 制需求为群组控制时, 通过第一信道向所述用户设备发送标识为所述辅 E-RNTI的绝对授权。
结合第八方面的第四种可能的实现方式或者第八方面的第五种可能 的实现方式, 在第八方面的第六种可能的实现方式中, 所述发送器, 还用 于在向所述用户设备发送标识为配置的 E-RNTI的绝对授权之后, 当所述 基站需要改变所述用户设备的辅 E-RNTI时, 向所述无线网络控制器发送 更新后的辅 E-RNTI, 并通知所述无线网络控制器进行辅 E-RNTI的变更, 以便所述无线网络控制器将所述更新后的辅 E-RNTI 发送给所述用户设 备。
结合第八方面,在第八方面的第七种可能的实现方式中,所述处理器, 具体用于为所述用户设备配置主 E-RNTI; 或者, 为所述用户设备配置主 E-RNTI和辅 E-RNTL
结合第八方面的第七种可能的实现方式, 在第八方面的第八种可能的 实现方式中, 所述发送器, 还用于在所述处理器为所述用户设备配置 E-RNTI之后, 将所述处理器为所述用户设备分配的 HARQ进程信息发送 给所述无线网络控制器。
结合第八方面的第八种可能的实现方式, 在第八方面的第九种可能的 实现方式中, 所述发送器, 还用于在将所述处理器为所述用户设备分配的 HARQ进程信息发送给所述无线网络控制器之后, 将所述用户设备的进程 状态信息发送给所述无线网络控制器, 以便所述无线网络控制器根据所述 进程状态信息初始配置或者重配置所述用户设备的进程状态。
结合第八方面的第七种可能的实现方式〜第八方面的第九种可能的实 现方式中的任意一种实现方式, 在第八方面的第十种可能的实现方式中, 所述发送器, 还用于在向所述用户设备发送标识为配置的 E-RNTI的绝对 授权之后, 向所述无线网络控制器发送所述绝对授权对应的进程状态信 息。 结合第八方面, 或者结合第八方面的第一种可能的实现方式〜第八方 面的第十种可能的实现方式中的任意一种实现方式, 在第八方面的第十一 种可能的实现方式中, 所述接收器, 还用于在接收到无线网络控制器发送 的用户设备的上行增强专用信道配置信息之后, 所述处理器为所述用户设 备配置增强专用信道无线网络临时标识 E-RNTI之前, 接收所述无线网络 控制器发送的指示消息, 所述指示消息用于指示所述基站进行无线链路建 立的消息配置。
结合第八方面, 或者结合第八方面的第一种可能的实现方式〜第八方 面的第十种可能的实现方式中的任意一种实现方式, 在第八方面的第十二 种可能的实现方式中,
所述处理器, 具体用于根据当前控制参考信息为所述用户设备配置
E-RNTI; 所述当前控制参考信息包括: 所述用户设备的速率、 所述用户设 备的数据块、 所述用户设备被分配的进程号、 所述用户设备对应的分组信 息和当前小区进程使用情况之一或组合。
本发明第九方面提供一种无线网络控制器, 包括:
接收器, 用于接收用户设备上报的所述用户设备支持上行增强专用信 道的能力; 以及在发送器将所述用户设备的上行增强专用信道配置信息发 送给基站之后, 接收所述基站发送的所述基站为所述用户设备配置的 E-RNTI;
所述发送器, 用于将所述用户设备的上行增强专用信道配置信息发送 给基站; 以及在所述接收器接收所述基站发送的所述基站为所述用户设备 配置的 E-RNTI之后, 将所述基站为所述用户设备配置的 E-RNTI发送给 所述用户设备,以便所述用户设备釆用所述配置的 E-RNTI监听第一信道, 并根据在所述第一信道中接收到的绝对授权激活或去激活混合自动重传 请求 HARQ进程。
结合第九方面, 在第九方面的第一种可能的实现方式中, 所述接收器 接收的所述基站为所述用户设备配置的 E-RNTI 包括第一 E-RNTI 和主 E-RNTI; 其中, 所述基站为所述用户设备所属的群组分配的 E-RNTI为所 述第一 E-RNTI。
结合第九方面的第一种可能的实现方式, 在第九方面的第二种可能的 实现方式中, 所述接收器, 还用于在所述发送器将所述基站为所述用户设 备配置的 E-RNTI发送给所述用户设备之后, 接收所述基站发送的更新后 的第一 E-RNTI, 以及接收所述基站发送的进行第一 E-RNTI 的变更的通 知; 所述发送器, 还用于将所述接收器接收的更新后的第一 E-RNTI发送 给所述用户设备。
结合第九方面, 在第九方面的第三种可能的实现方式中, 所述接收器 接收的所述基站为所述用户设备配置的 E-RNTI 包括主 E-RNTI 和辅 E-RNTI; 其中, 所述基站为所述用户设备所属的群组分配的 E-RNTI为所 述辅 E-RNTL
结合第九方面的第三种可能的实现方式, 在第九方面的第四种可能的 实现方式中, 所述接收器, 还用于在所述发送器将所述基站为所述用户设 备配置的 E-RNTI发送给所述用户设备之后, 接收所述基站发送的更新后 的辅 E-RNTI, 以及接收所述基站发送的进行辅 E-RNTI的变更的通知; 所 述发送器, 还用于将所述接收器接收的更新后的辅 E-RNTI发送给所述用 户设备。
结合第九方面, 在第九方面的第五种可能的实现方式中, 所述接收器 接收的所述基站为所述用户设备配置的 E-RNTI包括主 E-RNTI; 或者, 所 述接收器接收的所述基站为所述用户设备配置的 E-RNTI 包括主 E-RNTI 和辅 E-RNTL
结合第九方面的第五种可能的实现方式, 在第九方面的第六种可能的 实现方式中, 所述接收器, 还用于在所述发送器将所述用户设备的上行增 强专用信道配置信息发送给基站之后, 接收所述基站为所述用户设备分配 的 HARQ进程信息。
结合第九方面的第六种可能的实现方式, 在第九方面的第七种可能的 实现方式中, 所述无线网络控制器还包括: 处理器;
所述接收器,还用于在接收所述基站为所述用户设备分配的 HARQ进 程信息之后, 接收所述基站发送的所述用户设备的进程状态信息;
所述处理器, 用于根据所述接收器接收的进程状态信息初始配置或者 重配置所述用户设备的进程状态。
结合第九方面的第五种可能的实现方式〜第九方面的第七种可能的实 现方式中的任意一种实现方式, 在第九方面的第八种可能的实现方式中, 所述接收器, 还用于在所述发送器将所述基站为所述用户设备配置的
E-RNTI 发送给所述用户设备之后, 接收所述基站发送的所述用户设备的 进程状态信息。
结合第九方面, 或者结合第九方面的第一种可能的实现方式〜第九方 面的第八种可能的实现方式中的任意一种实现方式, 在第九方面的第九种 可能的实现方式中, 所述发送器, 还用于在将所述用户设备的上行增强专 用信道配置信息发送给基站之后, 所述接收器接收所述基站发送的所述基 站为所述用户设备配置的 E-RNTI之前, 向所述基站发送指示消息, 所述 指示消息用于指示所述基站进行无线链路建立的消息配置。
本发明的技术效果是: 用户设备向无线网络控制器上报该用户设备支 持上行增强专用信道的能力, 并接收上述无线网络控制器发送的配置消 息, 釆用上述配置消息携带的 E-RNTI监听第一信道, 该配置消息携带的 E-RNTI包括为上述用户设备所属的群组分配的 E-RNTI, 然后用户设备根 据在第一信道中接收到的绝对授权激活或去激活 HARQ进程。从而可以实 现根据上述配置消息携带的为上述用户设备所属的群组分配的 E-RNTI对 一个群组下的所有用户设备进行控制, 进而可以实现群组的激活或去激活 进程的操作, 减少了 E-AGCH的使用, 提高了下行码资源的使用效率, 避 免了下行吞吐量受限。 附图说明
实施例或现有技术描述中所需要使用的附图作一简单地介绍, 显而易见 地, 下面描述中的附图是本发明的一些实施例, 对于本领域普通技术人员 来讲, 在不付出创造性劳动性的前提下, 还可以根据这些附图获得其他的 附图。
图 1为本发明组调度授权的方法一个实施例的流程图;
图 2为本发明组调度授权的方法另一个实施例的流程图;
图 3为本发明组调度授权的方法再一个实施例的流程图;
图 4为本发明组调度授权的方法再一个实施例的流程图; 图 5为本发明组调度授权的方法再一个实施例的流程图; 图 6为本发明组调度授权的方法再一个实施例的流程图;
图 7为本发明组调度授权的方法再一个实施例的流程图;
图 8为本发明组调度授权的方法再一个实施例的流程图;
图 9为本发明组调度授权的方法再一个实施例的流程图;
图 10为本发明用户设备一个实施例的结构示意图;
图 11为本发明用户设备另一个实施例的结构示意图;
图 12为本发明基站一个实施例的结构示意图;
图 13为本发明无线网络控制器一个实施例的结构示意图;
图 14为本发明用户设备再一个实施例的结构示意图;
图 15为本发明基站另一个实施例的结构示意图;
图 16为本发明无线网络控制器另一个实施例的结构示意图。 具体实施方式 为使本发明实施例的目的、 技术方案和优点更加清楚, 下面将结合本 发明实施例中的附图, 对本发明实施例中的技术方案进行清楚、 完整地描 述, 显然, 所描述的实施例是本发明一部分实施例, 而不是全部的实施例。 基于本发明中的实施例, 本领域普通技术人员在没有作出创造性劳动前提 下所获得的所有其他实施例, 都属于本发明保护的范围。
图 1为本发明组调度授权的方法一个实施例的流程图, 如图 1所示, 该组调度授权的方法可以包括:
步骤 101 , UE向无线网络控制器 ( Radio Network Controller; 以下简 称: RNC ) 上报该 UE支持上行增强专用信道的能力。
步骤 102 , UE 接收该 RNC 发送的配置消息, 上述配置消息携带 E-RNTI; 该配置消息携带的 E-RNTI可以包括为上述 UE所属的群组分配 的 E-RNTI。
步骤 103 , UE釆用上述配置消息携带的 E-RNTI监听第一信道, 并根 据该 UE在第一信道中接收到的绝对授权激活或去激活 HARQ进程。
具体地, 上述绝对授权包括 UE的 HARQ进程的激活或去激活指示, 其中, UE的 HARQ进程的激活指示为具体的授权值。 本实施例中, 上述第一信道可以为 E-AGCH、公共 E-AGCH ( common E-AGCH ) 或非服务小区 E-AGCH ( non-serving E-AGCH ) 。
上述实施例中,UE向 RNC上报该 UE支持上行增强专用信道的能力, 并接收上述 RNC发送的配置消息,釆用上述配置消息携带的 E-RNTI监听 第一信道, 其中, 上述配置消息携带的 E-RNTI可以包括为 UE所属的群 组分配的 E-RNTI,然后 UE根据上述 UE在第一信道中接收到的绝对授权 激活或去激活 HARQ进程。 从而可以实现根据上述配置消息携带的为 UE 所属的群组分配的 E-RNTI对一个群组下的所有 UE进行控制, 进而可以 实现群组的激活或去激活进程的操作, 减少了 E-AGCH的使用,提高了下 行码资源的使用效率, 避免了下行吞吐量受限。
图 2为本发明组调度授权的方法另一个实施例的流程图,如图 2所示, 该组调度授权的方法可以包括:
步骤 201 ,基站接收到 RNC发送的 UE的上行增强专用信道配置信息 之后 , 为该 UE配置 E-RNTI。
步骤 202 , 基站将为上述 UE配置的 E-RNTI发送给 RNC , 以便 RNC 将基站为该 UE配置的 E-RNTI发送给 UE。
其中, 上述基站为 UE配置的 E-RNTI可以包括基站为 UE所属的群 组分配的 E-RNTL
步骤 203 ,基站通过第一信道向 UE发送标识为配置的 E-RNTI的绝对 授权。
本实施例中, 上述第一信道可以为 E-AGCH、公共 E-AGCH ( common E-AGCH ) 或非服务小区 E-AGCH ( non-serving E-AGCH ) 。
本实施例中, 基站接收到 RNC发送的 UE的上行增强专用信道配置 信息之后, 为该 UE配置 E-RNTI之前, 基站还可以接收上述 RNC发送的 指示消息, 该指示消息用于指示基站进行无线链路建立的消息配置。 也就 是说,基站可以在接收到 RNC发送的指示消息之后,再为 UE配置 E-RNTI。
具体地, 本实施例的一种实现方式中, 为该 UE配置 E-RNTI可以为: 基站为上述 UE配置第一 E-RNTI和主 E-RNTI; 或者, 基站为上述 UE配 置第一 E-RNTI、 主 E-RNTI和辅 E-RNTI。 本实现方式中, 基站为 UE所 属的群组分配的 E-RNTI为第一 E-RNTI, 该第一 E-RNTI可以为附加的主 E-RNTK additional Primary E-RNTI ) ,也可以为组 E-RNTK group E-RNTI )。 本实现方式中, 第一 E-RNTI是公共的, 基站为 UE所属群组中的所有 UE 配置相同的第一 E-RNTI。 这样 , 就可以通过该第一 E-RNTI对一个群组下 的所有 UE进行控制, 进而可以实现群组的激活或去激活进程的操作, 减 少了 E-AGCH的使用, 提高了下行码资源的使用效率,避免了下行吞吐量 受限。
本实现方式中, 基站通过第一信道向 UE发送标识为配置的 E-RNTI 的绝对授权可以为: 如果当前控制需求为单独控制, 则基站通过第一信道 向 UE发送标识为上述主 E-RNTI的绝对授权; 或者, 如果当前控制需求 为群组控制, 则基站通过第一信道向 UE发送标识为第一 E-RNTI的绝对 授权。
进一步地, 基站通过第一信道向 UE发送标识为配置的 E-RNTI的绝 对授权之后,如果基站需要改变上述 UE的第一 E-RNTI,则该基站向 RNC 发送更新后的第一 E-RNTI, 并通知 RNC进行第 ― E-RNTI的变更, 以便 RNC将上述更新后的第一 E-RNTI发送给 UE。
本实施例的另一种实现方式中, 为 UE配置 E-RNTI可以为: 基站为 上述 UE配置主 E-RNTI和辅 E-RNTI。 本实现方式中, 基站为 UE所属的 群组分配的 E-RNTI为辅 E-RNTI, 该辅 E-RNTI是公共的, 基站为 UE所 属群组中的所有 UE配置相同的辅 E-RNTI。这样 ,就可以通过该辅 E-RNTI 对一个群组下的所有 UE进行控制, 进而可以实现群组的激活或去激活进 程的操作, 减少了 E-AGCH的使用, 提高了下行码资源的使用效率, 避免 了下行吞吐量受限。
本实现方式中, 基站通过第一信道向 UE发送标识为配置的 E-RNTI 的绝对授权可以为: 如果当前控制需求为单独控制, 则基站通过第一信道 向 UE发送标识为上述主 E-RNTI的绝对授权; 或者, 如果当前控制需求 为群组控制, 则基站通过第一信道向上述 UE发送标识为辅 E-RNTI的绝 对授权。
进一步地, 基站通过第一信道向上述 UE发送标识为配置的 E-RNTI 的绝对授权之后,如果基站需要改变上述 UE的辅 E-RNTI,则基站向 RNC 发送更新后的辅 E-RNTI, 并通知 RNC进行辅 E-RNTI的变更, 以便 RNC 将上述更新后的辅 E-RNTI发送给 UE。
本实施例的再一种实现方式中, 为 UE配置 E-RNTI可以为: 基站为 上述 UE 配置主 E-RNTI; 或者, 基站为上述 UE 配置主 E-RNTI 和辅 E-RNTI。
进一步地, 为 UE配置 E-RNTI之后 , 基站将为 UE分配的 HARQ进 程信息发送给 RNC。 其中, 该 HARQ进程信息可以为允许 UE发送数据 的 HARQ进程的配置信息。
进一步地, 基站将为上述 UE分配的 HARQ进程信息发送给 RNC之 后, 基站将上述 UE的进程状态信息发送给 RNC, 以便 RNC根据上述进 程状态信息初始配置或者重配置 UE的进程状态。
进一步地, 基站通过第一信道向 UE发送标识为配置的 E-RNTI的绝 对授权之后, 上述基站向 RNC发送该 UE的进程状态信息, 这时, 接收 到该 UE的进程状态信息之后, RNC可以配置或不配置 UE的进程状态。
其中, 上述 UE的进程状态信息可以为 UE的 HARQ进程激活或去激 活状态信息、 HARQ进程的负载信息、 高低速指示消息和指示授权消息之 一或组合。
具体地, 本实施例中, 为 UE配置 E-RNTI可以为: 基站根据当前控 制参考信息为 UE配置 E-RNTI; 其中, 上述当前控制参考信息包括: 上述 UE的速率、 上述 UE的数据块、 上述 UE被分配的进程号、 上述 UE对应 的分组信息和当前小区进程使用情况之一或组合。
本实施例中,上述绝对授权包括 UE的 HARQ进程的激活或去激活指 示, 上述 UE的 HARQ进程的激活指示为具体的授权值。
上述实施例中, 基站接收到 RNC发送的 UE的上行增强专用信道配 置信息之后,为该 UE配置 E-RNTI;然后基站将为上述 UE配置的 E-RNTI 发送给 RNC , 由 RNC将基站为该 UE配置的 E-RNTI发送给 UE , 其中, 基站为该 UE配置的 E-RNTI可以包括基站为上述 UE所属的群组分配的 E-RNTI; 从而可以实现才艮据基站为上述 UE所属的群组分配的 E-RNTI对 一个群组下的所有 UE进行控制, 进而可以实现群组的激活或去激活进程 的操作, 减少了 E-AGCH的使用, 提高了下行码资源的使用效率, 避免了 下行吞吐量受限。 图 3为本发明组调度授权的方法再一个实施例的流程图,如图 3所示, 该组调度授权的方法可以包括:
步骤 301 , RNC接收 UE上报的该 UE支持上行增强专用信道的能力。 步骤 302, RNC将上述 UE的上行增强专用信道配置信息发送给基站。 本实施例中, RNC接收到 UE上报的该 UE支持上行增强专用信道的 能力之后, RNC将该 UE的上行增强专用信道配置信息发送给基站。其中, 该 UE的上行增强专用信道配置信息包括该 UE支持的上行增强专用信道 的帧偏移量等信息。
步骤 303 , RNC接收基站发送的该基站为上述 UE配置的 E-RNTL 其中, 该基站为上述 UE配置的 E-RNTI可以包括基站为 UE所属的 群组分配的 E-RNTI。
步骤 304, RNC将基站为上述 UE配置的 E-RNTI发送给 UE, 以便 UE釆用上述配置的 E-RNTI监听第一信道,并根据在第一信道中接收到的 绝对授权激活或去激活 HARQ进程。
本实施例中, 上述第一信道可以为 E-AGCH、公共 E-AGCH ( common
E-AGCH ) 或非服务小区 E-AGCH ( non-serving E-AGCH ) 。
本实施例中, 进一步地, 步骤 301之后, 步骤 303之前, RNC向上述 基站发送指示消息, 该指示消息用于指示基站进行无线链路建立的消息配 置。 也就是说, 基站可以在接收到 RNC发送的该指示消息之后, 再为 UE 配置 E-RNTL
具体地, 本实施例的一种实现方式中, 基站为 UE配置的 E-RNTI包 括第 ― E-RNTI和主 E-RNTI; 或者, 基站为 UE配置的 E-RNTI包括第 ― Ε-RNTL· 主 E-RNTI和辅 E-RNTI。 本实现方式中, 基站为 UE所属的群 组分配的 E-RNTI为第一 E-RNTI,该第一 E-RNTI可以为附加的主 E-RNTI ( additional Primary E-RNTI ) , 也可以为组 E-RNTI ( group E-RNTI ) 。 本实现方式中, 第一 E-RNTI是公共的, 基站为 UE所属群组中的所有 UE 配置相同的第一 E-RNTI。 这样 , 就可以通过该第一 E-RNTI对一个群组下 的所有 UE进行控制, 进而可以实现群组的激活或去激活进程的操作, 减 少了 E-AGCH的使用, 提高了下行码资源的使用效率,避免了下行吞吐量 受限。 进一步地, 将基站为 UE配置的 E-RNTI发送给 UE之后, RNC还可 以接收基站发送的更新后的第一 E-RNTI, 以及接收基站发送的进行第一 E-RNTI的变更的通知; 然后, RNC将更新后的第一 E-RNTI发送给 UE。
本实施例的另一种实现方式中, 基站为 UE 配置的 E-RNTI 包括主 E-RNTI和辅 E-RNTI。本实现方式中,基站为 UE所属的群组分配的 E-RNTI 为辅 E-RNTI, 该辅 E-RNTI是公共的 , 基站为 UE所属群组中的所有 UE 配置相同的辅 E-RNTI。 这样 , 就可以通过该辅 E-RNTI对一个群组下的所 有 UE进行控制, 进而可以实现群组的激活或去激活进程的操作, 减少了 E-AGCH的使用,提高了下行码资源的使用效率,避免了下行吞吐量受限。
进一步地, 将基站为 UE配置的 E-RNTI发送给上述 UE之后, RNC 还可以接收基站发送的更新后的辅 E-RNTI, 以及接收基站发送的进行辅 E-RNTI的变更的通知;然后, RNC将更新后的辅 E-RNTI发送给上述 UE。
本实施例的再一种实现方式中, 基站为 UE 配置的 E-RNTI 包括主 E-RNTI;或者,基站为上述 UE配置的 E-RNTI包括主 E-RNTI和辅 E-RNTI。
进一步地, RNC将上述 UE的上行增强专用信道配置信息发送给基站 之后, RNC还可以接收基站为上述 UE分配的 HARQ进程信息。 其中, 该 HARQ进程信息可以为允许 UE发送数据的 HARQ进程的配置信息。
进一步地, RNC接收基站为上述 UE分配的 HARQ进程信息之后, RNC还可以接收基站发送的上述 UE的进程状态信息; 然后, RNC根据 上述进程状态信息初始配置或者重配置 UE的进程状态。
进一步地, 将基站为上述 UE配置的 E-RNTI发送给 UE之后, RNC 还可以接收基站发送的上述 UE的进程状态信息, 这时, 接收到该 UE的 进程状态信息之后, RNC可以配置或不配置 UE的进程状态。
其中, 上述 UE的进程状态信息可以为 UE的 HARQ进程激活或去激 活状态信息、 HARQ进程的负载信息、 高低速指示消息和指示授权消息之 一或组合。
上述实施例中, RNC接收 UE上报的该 UE支持上行增强专用信道的 能力之后, 将上述 UE的上行增强专用信道配置信息发送给基站, 接收基 站发送的该基站为上述 UE配置的 E-RNTI, 并将基站为上述 UE配置的 E-RNTI发送给 UE , 其中, 该基站为上述 UE配置的 E-RNTI可以包括基 站为 UE所属的群组分配的 E-RNTI,从而可以实现才艮据基站为 UE所属的 群组分配的 E-RNTI对一个群组下的所有 UE进行控制, 进而可以实现群 组的激活或去激活进程的操作, 减少了 E-AGCH的使用, 提高了下行码资 源的使用效率, 避免了下行吞吐量受限。
图 4为本发明组调度授权的方法再一个实施例的流程图,如图 4所示, 该组调度授权的方法可以包括:
步骤 401 , UE向 RNC上报该 UE支持上行增强专用信道的能力。 具体地,UE向 RNC上报该 UE支持上行增强专用信道的能力可以为: 该 UE向上述 RNC上报该 UE在上行增强专用信道操作期间支持接收标识 为第一 E-RNTI的绝对授权的能力。
具体地, UE可以通过无线资源控制( Radio Resource Control; 以下简 称: RRC ) 连接建立请求或者 RRC连接建立完成消息向 RNC上报该 UE 支持接收标识为第一 E-RNTI的绝对授权的能力。
步骤 402 , UE 接收该 RNC 发送的配置消息, 上述配置消息携带 E-RNTI。
具体地,上述配置消息携带的 E-RNTI包括第一 E-RNTI和主 E-RNTI; 或者, 上述配置消息携带的 E-RNTI 包括第一 E-RNTI、 主 E-RNTI和辅 E-RNTI。 其中, 第一 E-RNTI为基站为 UE所属的群组分配的 E-RNTI, 该第一 E-RNTI可以为附加的主 E-RNTI ( additional Primary E-RNTI ) , 也 可以为组 E-RNTI ( group E-RNTI )。 本实施例中, 第一 E-RNTI是公共的, 基站为 UE所属群组中的所有 UE配置相同的第一 E-RNTI。 这样, 就可以 通过该第一 E-RNTI对一个群组下的所有 UE进行控制, 进而可以实现群 组的激活或去激活进程的操作, 减少了 E-AGCH的使用, 提高了下行码资 源的使用效率, 避免了下行吞吐量受限。
其中, 上述配置消息可以为无线承载建立、 无线承载重配置或者 RRC 连接建立等 RRC消息。
步骤 403 , UE釆用上述配置消息携带的 E-RNTI监听第一信道, 当该 UE在第一信道中接收到标识为第 ― E-RNTI或主 E-RNTI的绝对授权时 , UE确定标识为第一 E-RNTI或主 E-RNTI的绝对授权的类型为主授权。
本实施例中, 上述第一信道可以为 E-AGCH、公共 E-AGCH ( common E-AGCH ) 或非服务小区 E-AGCH ( non-serving E-AGCH ) 。
步骤 404, UE根据该 UE在第一信道中接收到的绝对授权激活或去激 活 HARQ进程。
具体地, 本实施例的一种实现方式中, UE根据该 UE在第一信道中 接收到的绝对授权激活或去激活 HARQ进程可以为:如果 UE在第一信道 中接收到的绝对授权的标识为第一 E-RNTI, 并且上述绝对授权的绝对授 权值为去激活命令, 则当上述绝对授权的绝对授权范围为每 HARQ ( per HARQ ) 进程和已配置 2毫秒 TTI时 , UE去激活当前 TTI对应的 HARQ 进程号所对应的 HARQ进程; 或者, 当上述绝对授权的绝对授权范围为所 有 HARQ进程、 已配置 2毫秒 TTI并且未配置辅 E-RNTI时 , UE去激活 所有 HARQ进程; 或者, 当上述绝对授权的绝对授权范围为所有 HARQ 进程和已配置辅 E-RNTI时, UE激活所有 HARQ进程, 将服务授权设置 为储存第二授权值, 并将主授权有效性设置为假;
本实施例的另一种实现方式中, UE根据该 UE在第一信道中接收到 的绝对授权激活或去激活 HARQ进程可以为: 如果 UE在第一信道中接收 到的绝对授权的标识为第一 E-RNTI, 并且上述绝对授权的绝对授权值不 是去激活命令, 则当绝对授权的绝对授权范围为每 HARQ进程时, UE激 活当前 TTI对应的 HARQ进程号所对应的 HARQ进程; 或者, 当上述绝 对授权的绝对授权范围为所有 HARQ进程时, UE激活所有 HARQ进程。
本实施例的再一种实现方式中, UE根据该 UE在第一信道中接收到 的绝对授权激活或去激活 HARQ进程可以为: 如果 UE在第一信道中接收 到的绝对授权的标识为第一 E-RNTI, 并且上述绝对授权的绝对授权值不 是去激活命令,则 UE激活当前 TTI对应的 HARQ进程号所对应的 HARQ 进程 , 并去激活所有 HARQ进程中除当前 TTI对应的 HARQ进程号所对 应的 HARQ进程之外的 HARQ进程。
另外, 本实施例的再一种实现方式中, 如果 UE在第一信道中接收到 的绝对授权的标识为第一 E-RNTI, 并且上述绝对授权的绝对授权值不是 去激活命令, 则 UE将主授权有效性设置为真。
本实施例的再一种实现方式中, 如果 UE在第一信道中接收到的绝对 授权的标识为第一 E-RNTI, 并且上述绝对授权的绝对授权值不是去激活 命令, 则当上述绝对授权的定时器处于未触发状态时, UE 启动上述定时 器, 或者, 当上述绝对授权的定时器处于触发状态时, UE 重置上述定时 器。
本实施例的再一种实现方式中, 如果 UE在第一信道中接收到的绝对 授权的标识为第一 E-RNTI、主 E-RNTI或者主授权有效性设置为假, 并且 上述绝对授权的绝对授权值不是去激活命令, 则当上述绝对授权的绝对授 权值不是零授权命令时, UE 将服务授权设置为上述绝对授权值与最小配 置服务授权值中的最大值; 或者, 当上述绝对授权的绝对授权值为零授权 命令时, UE将服务授权设置为零授权。
上述实施例中, UE向 RNC上报该 UE在上行增强专用信道操作期间 支持接收标识为第一 E-RNTI的绝对授权的能力,并接收上述 RNC发送的 配置消息, 然后 UE釆用上述配置消息携带的 E-RNTI监听第一信道, 其 中, 上述配置消息携带的 E-RNTI 包括为 UE 所属的群组分配的第一 E-RNTI; 然后 UE根据上述 UE在第一信道中接收到的绝对授权激活或去 激活 HARQ进程。从而可以实现根据上述配置消息携带的第一 E-RNTI对 一个群组下的所有 UE进行控制, 进而可以实现群组的激活或去激活进程 的操作, 减少了 E-AGCH的使用, 提高了下行码资源的使用效率, 避免了 下行吞吐量受限。
图 5为本发明组调度授权的方法再一个实施例的流程图,如图 5所示, 该组调度授权的方法可以包括:
步骤 501 , 当 RNC接收到 UE上报的该 UE在上行增强专用信道操作 期间支持接收标识为第 ― E-RNTI的绝对授权的能力时, RNC将 UE的上 行增强专用信道配置信息通过第一消息发送给基站。
其中, 该 UE的上行增强专用信道配置信息包括该 UE支持的上行增 强专用信道的帧偏移量等信息。
具体地, 上述第一消息可以是无线链路建立、 无线链路添加或者无线 链路重配等消息。
步骤 502, 基站根据当前控制参考信息给上述 UE配置 E-RNTI, 并将 该基站为 UE配置的 E-RNTI通过第二消息告知给 RNC。
具体地, 基站给上述 UE配置的 E-RNTI可以包括第一 E-RNTI和主 E-RNTI; 或者, 基站给上述 UE配置的 E-RNTI可以包括第一 E-RNTI、 主 E-RNTI和辅 E-RNTI。
其中, 第一 E-RNTI为基站为 UE所属的群组分配的 E-RNTI, 该第一 E-RNTI可以为附加的主 E-RNTI ( additional Primary E-RNTI ) , 也可以为 组 E-RNTI ( group E-RNTI ) 。 本实施例中, 第一 E-RNTI是公共的, 基站 为 UE所属群组中的所有 UE配置相同的第一 E-RNTI。 这样, 就可以通过 该第一 E-RNTI对一个群组下的所有 UE进行控制, 进而可以实现群组的 激活或去激活进程的操作, 减少了 E-AGCH的使用, 提高了下行码资源的 使用效率, 避免了下行吞吐量受限。
其中, 上述当前控制参考信息可以为: 上述 UE的速率、 上述 UE的 数据块、 上述 UE被分配的进程号、 上述 UE对应的分组信息和当前小区 进程使用情况之一或组合。
具体地, 上述第二消息可以为无线链路建立响应消息、 无线链路添加 响应消息、 无线链路重配响应消息或者无线链路参数更新消息等消息。
步骤 503 , 当 RNC收到基站为 UE配置的 E-RNTI时, RNC将该基站 为 UE配置的 E-RNTI通过第三消息发送给 UE。
具体地, 上述第三消息可以为无线承载建立、 无线承载重配置或者 RRC连接建立等 RRC消息。
步骤 504, 基站根据当前控制需求选择 E-RNTI, 通过第一信道向 UE 发送标识为选择的 E-RNTI的绝对授权。
具体地, 如果当前控制需求为单独控制, 则基站选择主 E-RNTI, 并 通过第一信道向 UE发送标识为上述主 E-RNTI的绝对授权; 或者, 如果 当前控制需求为群组控制, 则基站选择第一 E-RNTI, 并通过第一信道向 UE发送标识为第 ― E-RNTI的绝对授权。
进一步地, 本实施例中, 步骤 504之后, 如果基站需要改变 UE的第
― E-RNTI, 可以通过第二消息向 RNC发送更新后的第一 E-RNTI, 并通 知 RNC进行第 ― E-RNTI的变更。接下来, RNC会将更新后的第一 E-RNTI 通过第三消息发送给 UE。
本实施例中, 步骤 501 , RNC将 UE的上行增强专用信道配置信息通 过第一消息发送给基站之后,基站还可以将上述 UE的 2毫秒 HARQ进程 使用信息通过第二消息告知 RNC。其中, 具体的进程使用信息可以是各进 程激活或去激活, 或各进程是否为零授权。
本实施例中, 步骤 501之后, 步骤 502之前, RNC还可以向上述基站 发送指示消息, 该指示消息用于指示基站进行无线链路建立的消息配置。 也就是说, 基站可以在接收到 RNC发送的该指示消息之后, 再为 UE配 置 E-RNTI。
本实施例可以实现根据基站为 UE所属的群组分配的第一 E-RNTI对 一个群组下的所有 UE进行控制, 进而可以实现群组的激活或去激活进程 的操作, 减少了 E-AGCH的使用, 提高了下行码资源的使用效率, 避免了 下行吞吐量受限。
图 6为本发明组调度授权的方法再一个实施例的流程图,如图 6所示, 该组调度授权的方法可以包括:
步骤 601 , UE向 RNC上报该 UE支持上行增强专用信道的能力。 本实施例中, UE向 RNC上报该 UE支持上行增强专用信道的能力, 即隐式告知 RNC该 UE支持接收标识为主 E-RNTI和辅 E-RNTI的绝对授 权的能力。
步骤 602 , UE接收 RNC发送的配置消息,上述配置消息携带主 E-RNTI 和辅 E-RNTL
其中, 辅 E-RNTI 为基站为 UE 所属的群组分配的 E-RNTI, 该辅 E-RNTI 是公共的, 基站为 UE 所属群组中的所有 UE 配置相同的辅 E-RNTI。 这样 , 就可以通过该辅 E-RNTI对一个群组下的所有 UE进行控 制, 进而可以实现群组的激活或去激活进程的操作, 减少了 E-AGCH的使 用, 提高了下行码资源的使用效率, 避免了下行吞吐量受限。
具体地, 上述配置消息可以为无线承载建立消息、 无线承载重配置或 者 RRC连接建立等 RRC消息。
步骤 603 , UE釆用上述主 E-RNTI和辅 E-RNTI来监听第一信道。 本实施例中, 上述第一信道可以为 E-AGCH、公共 E-AGCH ( common E-AGCH ) 或非服务小区 E-AGCH ( non-serving E-AGCH ) 。
步骤 604, UE根据该 UE在第一信道中接收到的绝对授权激活或去激 活 HARQ进程。 具体地, 当 UE在第一信道中收到标识为辅 E-RNTI的绝对授权时, UE根据该绝对授权的绝对授权范围,确定上述标识为辅 E-RNTI的绝对授 权的作用进程范围。
本实施例的一种实现方式中, UE根据该 UE在第一信道中接收到的 绝对授权激活或去激活 HARQ进程可以为:如果 UE在上述第一信道中接 收到的绝对授权的标识为辅 E-RNTI, 并且上述绝对授权的绝对授权值为 去激活命令,则当上述绝对授权的绝对授权范围为每 HARQ进程和已配置 2毫秒 TTI时 , UE去激活当前 TTI对应的 HARQ进程号所对应的 HARQ 进程; 或者, 当上述绝对授权的绝对授权范围为所有 HARQ进程和已配置 2毫秒 TTI时, UE去激活所有 HARQ进程;
本实施例的另一种实现方式中, UE根据该 UE在第一信道中接收到 的绝对授权激活或去激活 HARQ进程可以为: 如果 UE在第一信道中接收 到的绝对授权的标识为辅 E-RNTI, 并且上述绝对授权的绝对授权值不是 去激活命令, 则当上述绝对授权的绝对授权范围为每 HARQ进程时, UE 激活当前 TTI对应的 HARQ进程号所对应的 HARQ进程; 或者, 当上述 绝对授权的绝对授权范围为所有 HARQ进程时, UE激活所有 HARQ进程。
本实施例的另一种实现方式中, UE根据该 UE在第一信道中接收到 的绝对授权激活或去激活 HARQ进程可以为: 如果 UE在第一信道中接收 到的绝对授权的标识为辅 E-RNTI, 并且上述绝对授权的绝对授权值不是 去激活命令, 则 UE激活当前 ΤΉ对应的 HARQ进程号所对应的 HARQ 进程 , 并去激活所有 HARQ进程中除当前 TTI对应的 HARQ进程号所对 应的 HARQ进程之外的 HARQ进程。
另外, 本实施例的再一种实现方式中, 如果 UE在第一信道中接收到 的绝对授权的标识为辅 E-RNTI, 并且上述绝对授权的绝对授权值不是去 激活命令, 则当上述绝对授权值不是零授权命令时, UE 将服务授权设置 为上述绝对授权值与最小配置服务授权值中的最大值; 或者, 当上述绝对 授权值是零授权命令时, UE将服务授权设置为零授权。
本实施例的再一种实现方式中, 如果 UE在上述第一信道中接收到的 绝对授权的标识为辅 E-RNTI, 并且上述绝对授权的绝对授权值不是去激 活命令, 则当上述绝对授权的定时器处于未触发状态时, UE 启动上述定 时器; 或者, 当上述绝对授权的定时器处于触发状态时, UE 重置上述定 时器。
上述实施例中,UE向 RNC上报该 UE支持上行增强专用信道的能力, 并接收上述 RNC 发送的配置消息, 然后 UE 釆用上述配置消息携带的 E-RNTI监听第一信道, 其中, 该配置消息携带的 E-RNTI可以包括基站为 UE所属的群组分配的辅 E-RNTI。 然后 UE根据上述 UE在第一信道中接 收到的绝对授权激活或去激活 HARQ进程。从而可以实现根据上述配置消 息携带的辅 E-RNTI对一个群组下的所有 UE进行控制, 进而可以实现群 组的激活或去激活进程的操作, 减少了 E-AGCH的使用, 提高了下行码资 源的使用效率, 避免了下行吞吐量受限。
图 7为本发明组调度授权的方法再一个实施例的流程图,如图 7所示, 该组调度授权的方法可以包括:
步骤 701 , 当 RNC接收到 UE上报的该 UE支持上行增强专用信道的 能力时, RNC将 UE的上行增强专用信道配置信息通过第一消息发送给基 站。
其中, 该 UE的上行增强专用信道配置信息包括该 UE支持的上行增 强专用信道的帧偏移量等信息。
具体地, 上述第一消息可以是无线链路建立、 无线链路添加或者无线 链路重配等消息。
步骤 702, 基站根据当前控制参考信息给上述 UE配置 E-RNTI, 并将 该基站为 UE配置的 E-RNTI通过第二消息告知给 RNC。
具体地,基站给上述 UE配置的 E-RNTI包括主 E-RNTI和辅 E-RNTL 该辅 E-RNTI为基站为 UE所属的群组分配的 E-RNTI, 该辅 E-RNTI是公 共的, 基站为 UE所属群组中的所有 UE配置相同的辅 E-RNTI。 这样, 就 可以通过该辅 E-RNTI对一个群组下的所有 UE进行控制 , 进而可以实现 群组的激活或去激活进程的操作, 减少了 E-AGCH的使用, 提高了下行码 资源的使用效率, 避免了下行吞吐量受限。
其中, 上述当前控制参考信息可以为: 上述 UE的速率、 上述 UE的 数据块、 上述 UE被分配的进程号、 上述 UE对应的分组信息和当前小区 进程使用情况之一或组合。 具体地, 上述第二消息可以为无线链路建立响应消息、 无线链路添加 响应消息、 无线链路重配响应消息或者无线链路参数更新消息等消息。
步骤 703 , 当 RNC收到基站为 UE配置的 E-RNTI时, RNC将上述基 站为 UE配置的 E-RNTI通过第三消息发送给 UE。
具体地, 上述第三消息可以为无线承载建立、 无线承载重配置或者
RRC连接建立等 RRC消息。
步骤 704, 基站根据当前控制需求选择 E-RNTI, 通过第一信道向 UE 发送标识为选择的 E-RNTI的绝对授权。
具体地, 如果当前控制需求为单独控制, 则基站选择主 E-RNTI, 并 通过第一信道向 UE发送标识为上述主 E-RNTI的绝对授权; 或者, 如果 当前控制需求为群组控制, 则基站选择辅 E-RNTI, 并通过第一信道向上 述 UE发送标识为辅 E-RNTI的绝对授权。
进一步地, 步骤 704之后, 如果基站需要改变 UE的辅 E-RNTI, 可以 通过第二消息向 RNC 发送更新后的辅 E-RNTI , 并通知 RNC 进行辅 E-RNTI的变更。 接下来, RNC会将更新后的辅 E-RNTI通过第三消息发 送给 UE。
本实施例中, RNC将 UE的上行增强专用信道配置信息通过第一消息 发送给基站之后,将该基站为 UE配置的 E-RNTI通过第二消息告知给 RNC 之前, RNC还可以向上述基站发送指示消息, 该指示消息用于指示基站进 行无线链路建立的消息配置。 也就是说, 基站可以在接收到 RNC发送的 该指示消息之后, 再为 UE配置 E-RNTI。
本实施例可以实现根据基站为 UE所属的群组分配的辅 E-RNTI对一 个群组下的所有 UE进行控制, 进而可以实现群组的激活或去激活进程的 操作, 减少了 E-AGCH的使用, 提高了下行码资源的使用效率, 避免了下 行吞吐量受限。
图 8为本发明组调度授权的方法再一个实施例的流程图,如图 8所示, 该组调度授权的方法可以包括:
步骤 801 , UE向 RNC上报该 UE支持上行增强专用信道的能力。 本实施例中, UE向 RNC上报该 UE支持上行增强专用信道的能力, 即隐式告知 RNC该 UE支持接收标识为主 E-RNTI的绝对授权或者标识为 主 E-RNTI和辅 E-RNTI的绝对授权的能力。
步骤 802, UE接收 RNC发送的配置消息,上述配置消息携带 E-RNTI。 本实施例中, 上述配置消息可以为无线承载建立消息、 无线承载重配 置或者 RRC连接建立等 RRC消息。
其中, 上述配置消息携带的 E-RNTI包括主 E-RNTI; 或者, 上述配置 消息携带的 E-RNTI包括主 E-RNTI和辅 E-RNTI。
步骤 803 , UE釆用上述配置消息携带的 E-RNTI监听第一信道, 当
UE在第一信道中收到标识为主 E-RNTI的绝对授权时, UE确定标识为主
E-RNTI的绝对授权的类型为主授权。
步骤 804, UE根据该 UE在第一信道中接收到的绝对授权激活或去激 活 HARQ进程。
具体地, 本实施例的一种实现方式中, UE根据该 UE在第一信道中 接收到的绝对授权激活或去激活 HARQ进程可以为:如果该 UE在第一信 道中接收到的绝对授权的标识为主 E-RNTI, 并且上述绝对授权的绝对授 权值为去激活命令,则当上述绝对授权的绝对授权范围为每 HARQ进程和 已配置 2毫秒 TTI时 , UE去激活当前 TTI对应的 HARQ进程号所对应的 HARQ进程; 或者, 当上述绝对授权的绝对授权范围为所有 HARQ进程、 已配置 2毫秒 TTI和没有配置辅 E-RNTI时, UE去激活所有 HARQ进程; 或者, 当上述绝对授权的绝对授权范围为所有 HARQ 进程和已配置辅 E-RNTI时, UE激活所有 HARQ进程, 将服务授权设置为储存第二授权 值, 并将主授权有效性设置为假。
本实施例的另一种实现方式中, UE根据该 UE在第一信道中接收到 的绝对授权激活或去激活 HARQ进程可以为: 如果 UE在第一信道中接收 到的绝对授权的标识为主 E-RNTI, 并且上述绝对授权的绝对授权值不是 去激活命令, 则当上述绝对授权的绝对授权范围为每 HARQ进程时, UE 去激活当前 TTI对应的 HARQ进程号所对应的 HARQ进程; 或者 , 当上 述绝对授权的绝对授权范围为所有 HARQ进程时, UE激活所有 HARQ进 程。
另外, 本实施例的再一种实现方式中, 如果 UE在第一信道中接收到 的绝对授权的标识为主 E-RNTI, 并且上述绝对授权的绝对授权值不是去 激活命令, 则 UE将主授权有效性设置为真。
本实施例的再一种实现方式中, 如果 UE在第一信道中接收到的绝对 授权的标识为主 E-RNTI, 并且上述绝对授权的绝对授权值不是去激活命 令, 则当上述绝对授权的定时器处于未触发状态时, UE启动上述定时器, 或者, 当上述绝对授权的定时器处于触发状态时, UE重置上述定时器。
本实施例的再一种实现方式中, 如果 UE在第一信道中接收到的绝对 授权的标识为主 E-RNTI或者主授权有效性设置为假, 并且上述绝对授权 的绝对授权值不是去激活命令, 则当上述绝对授权的绝对授权值不是零授 权命令时, UE 将服务授权设置为上述绝对授权值与最小配置服务授权值 中的最大值; 或者, 当上述绝对授权的绝对授权值为零授权命令时, UE 将服务授权设置为零授权。
上述实施例中,UE向 RNC上报该 UE支持上行增强专用信道的能力, 并接收上述 RNC 发送的配置消息, 然后 UE 釆用上述配置消息携带的 E-RNTI监听第一信道,并根据上述 UE在第一信道中接收到的绝对授权激 活或去激活 HARQ进程。 从而可以实现激活或去激活进程的操作。
图 9为本发明组调度授权的方法再一个实施例的流程图,如图 9所示, 该组调度授权的方法可以包括:
步骤 901 , 当 RNC接收到 UE上报的该 UE支持上行增强专用信道的 能力时, RNC将 UE的上行增强专用信道配置信息通过第一消息发送给基 站。
具体地, 上述第一消息可以是无线链路建立、 无线链路添加或者无线 链路重配等消息。
步骤 902, 基站根据当前控制参考信息给上述 UE配置 E-RNTI, 并将 该基站为 UE配置的 E-RNTI和该基站为该 UE分配的 HARQ进程信息通 过第二消息发送给 RNC。
其中, 该 HARQ进程信息可以为允许 UE发送数据的 HARQ进程的 配置信息。
具体地, 基站给上述 UE配置的 E-RNTI包括主 E-RNTI; 或者, 基站 给上述 UE配置的 E-RNTI包括主 E-RNTI和辅 E-RNTI。
其中, 上述当前控制参考信息可以为: 上述 UE的速率、 上述 UE的 数据块、 上述 UE被分配的进程号、 上述 UE对应的分组信息和当前小区 进程使用情况之一或组合。
具体地, 上述第二消息可以为无线链路建立响应消息、 无线链路添加 响应消息、 无线链路重配响应消息或者无线链路参数更新消息等消息。
步骤 903 , 当 RNC收到基站为 UE配置的 E-RNTI时, RNC将上述基 站为 UE配置的 E-RNTI通过第三消息发送给 UE。
具体地, 上述第三消息可以为无线承载建立、 无线承载重配置或者 RRC连接建立等 RRC消息。
步骤 904, 基站根据当前控制需求选择 E-RNTI, 通过第一信道向 UE 发送标识为选择的 E-RNTI的绝对授权。
本实施例中,上述绝对授权包括 UE的 HARQ进程的激活或去激活指 示, 上述 UE的 HARQ进程的激活指示为具体的授权值。
进一步地, 步骤 904之后, 基站向 RNC发送 UE的进程状态信息, 这时, 接收到该 UE的进程状态信息之后, RNC可以配置或不配置 UE的 进程状态。
另外, 本实施例中, 步骤 902中,基站将该基站为 UE配置的 E-RNTI 和该基站为该 UE分配的 HARQ进程信息通过第二消息发送给 RNC之后, 基站还可以将上述 UE的进程状态信息发送给 RNC,然后 RNC根据该 UE 的进程状态信息初始配置或者重配置该 UE的进程状态信息。具体地, RNC 可以根据一个 UE的进程状态信息对这一个 UE的进程状态进行初始配置 或者重配置; 或者, RNC也可以根据至少两个 UE的进程状态信息对这至 少两个 UE的进程状态进行初始配置或者重配置, 这时 RNC可以对一个 群组下的所有 UE进行控制, 进而可以实现群组的激活或去激活进程的操 作, 减少了 E-AGCH的使用, 提高了下行码资源的使用效率, 避免了下行 吞吐量受限。
其中, 上述 UE的进程状态信息可以为 UE的 HARQ进程激活或去激 活状态信息、 HARQ进程的负载信息、 高低速指示消息和指示授权消息之 一或组合。
上述实施例可以实现 RNC根据 UE的进程状态信息对该 UE的进程状 态进行配置, 进而可以实现对一个群组下的所有 UE进行控制, 进而可以 实现群组的激活或去激活进程的操作, 减少了 E-AGCH的使用,提高了下 行码资源的使用效率, 避免了下行吞吐量受限。
本领域普通技术人员可以理解: 实现上述方法实施例的全部或部分步 骤可以通过程序指令相关的硬件来完成, 前述的程序可以存储于一计算机 可读取存储介质中, 该程序在执行时, 执行包括上述方法实施例的步骤; 而前述的存储介质包括: ROM、 RAM, 磁碟或者光盘等各种可以存储程 序代码的介质。
图 10为本发明用户设备一个实施例的结构示意图, 本实施例中的 UE 可以实现本发明图 1所示实施例的流程, 如图 10所示, 该 UE可以包括: 上报模块 1001、 接收模块 1002、 监听模块 1003和激活 /去激活模块 1004; 其中, 上报模块 1001 , 用于向 RNC上报该 UE支持上行增强专用信 道的能力;
接收模块 1002, 用于接收 RNC 发送的配置消息, 该配置消息携带 E-RNTI; 其中, 该配置消息携带的 E-RNTI可以包括为 UE所属的群组分 配的 E-RNTI;
监听模块 1003 , 用于釆用接收模块 1002 接收的配置消息携带的 E-RNTI监听第一信道;
激活 /去激活模块 1004, 用于根据监听模块 1003在第一信道中接收到 的绝对授权激活或去激活 HARQ进程。
本实施例中, 上述第一信道可以为 E-AGCH、公共 E-AGCH ( common
E-AGCH ) 或非服务小区 E-AGCH ( non-serving E-AGCH ) 。
本实施例中,上述绝对授权包括 UE的 HARQ进程的激活或去激活指 示, 上述 UE的 HARQ进程的激活指示为具体的授权值。
上述实施例中, 上报模块 1001向 RNC上报该 UE支持上行增强专用 信道的能力, 接收模块 1002接收上述 RNC发送的配置消息, 然后监听模 块 1003釆用上述配置消息携带的 E-RNTI监听第一信道, 其中, 该配置消 息携带的 E-RNTI可以包括为 UE所属的群组分配的 E-RNTI; 激活 /去激 活模块 1004根据监听模块 1003在第一信道中接收到的绝对授权激活或去 激活 HARQ进程。从而可以实现根据上述配置消息携带的为 UE所属的群 组分配的 E-RNTI对一个群组下的所有 UE进行控制, 进而可以实现群组 的激活或去激活进程的操作, 减少了 E-AGCH的使用,提高了下行码资源 的使用效率, 避免了下行吞吐量受限。
图 11为本发明用户设备另一个实施例的结构示意图, 与图 10所示的 UE相比, 不同之处在于, 本实施例的一种实现方式中, 接收模块 1002接 收的配置消息携带的 E-RNTI包括第一 E-RNTI和主 E-RNTI; 或者, 接收 模块 1002接收的配置消息携带的 E-RNTI包括第一 E-RNTI、 主 E-RNTI 和辅 E-RNTI; 本实现方式中, 为上述 UE所属的群组分配的 E-RNTI为第 ― E-RNTI,上述第 ― E-RNTI可以为附加的主 E-RNTI ( additional Primary E-RNTI ) , 也可以为组 E-RNTI ( group E-RNTI ) ; 本实现方式中, 第一 E-RNTI 是公共的, 基站为 UE 所属群组中的所有 UE 配置相同的第一 E-RNTI。 这样 , 就可以通过该第一 E-RNTI对一个群组下的所有 UE进行 控制, 进而可以实现群组的激活或去激活进程的操作, 减少了 E-AGCH的 使用, 提高了下行码资源的使用效率, 避免了下行吞吐量受限。
本实现方式中, 该 UE还可以包括: 第一确定模块 1005;
第一确定模块 1005 , 用于在激活 /去激活模块 1004 激活或去激活
HARQ 进程之前, 当监听模块 1003 在第一信道中接收到标识为第一 E-RNTI或主 E-RNTI的绝对授权时 ,确定标识为第 ― E-RNTI或主 E-RNTI 的绝对授权的类型为主授权。
本实现方式的一种具体实现方式中, 激活 /去激活模块 1004, 具体用 于当监听模块 1003 在第一信道中接收到的绝对授权的标识为第一 E-RNTI, 并且该绝对授权的绝对授权值为去激活命令时, 如果上述绝对授 权的绝对授权范围为每 HARQ进程和已配置 2毫秒 TTI , 则去激活当前 TTI对应的 HARQ进程号所对应的 HARQ进程; 或者, 如果上述绝对授 权的绝对授权范围为所有 HARQ进程、 已配置 2毫秒 TTI并且未配置辅 E-RNTI, 则去激活所有 HARQ进程; 或者, 如果上述绝对授权的绝对授 权范围为所有 HARQ进程和已配置辅 E-RNTI , 则激活所有 HARQ进程, 将服务授权设置为储存第二授权值, 并将主授权有效性设置为假。
本实现方式的另一种具体实现方式中, 激活 /去激活模块 1004, 具体 用于当监听模块 1003 在第一信道中接收到的绝对授权的标识为第一 E-RNTI, 并且上述绝对授权的绝对授权值不是去激活命令时, 如果上述绝 对授权的绝对授权范围为每 HARQ进程, 则激活当前 TTI对应的 HARQ 进程号所对应的 HARQ进程; 或者,如果上述绝对授权的绝对授权范围为 所有 HARQ进程, 则激活所有 HARQ进程。
本实现方式的再一种具体实现方式中, 激活 /去激活模块 1004, 具体 用于当监听模块 1003 在第一信道中接收到的绝对授权的标识为第一 E-RNTI, 并且上述绝对授权的绝对授权值不是去激活命令时, 激活当前 TTI对应的 HARQ进程号所对应的 HARQ进程, 并去激活所有 HARQ进 程中除当前 TTI对应的 HARQ进程号所对应的 HARQ进程之外的 HARQ 进程。
本实现方式中, 上述 UE还可以包括: 第一设置模块 1006;
其中, 第一设置模块 1006, 用于当监听模块 1003在第一信道中接收 到的绝对授权的标识为第一 E-RNTI, 并且上述绝对授权的绝对授权值不 是去激活命令时, 将主授权有效性设置为真;
或者,
第一设置模块 1006, 用于当监听模块 1003在第一信道中接收到的绝 对授权的标识为第一 E-RNTI, 并且该绝对授权的绝对授权值不是去激活 命令时,如果上述绝对授权的定时器处于未触发状态,则启动上述定时器, 或者, 如果上述绝对授权的定时器处于触发状态, 则重置上述定时器; 或者,
第一设置模块 1006, 用于当监听模块 1003在第一信道中接收到的绝 对授权的标识为第一 E-RNTI、主 E-RNTI或者主授权有效性设置为假, 并 且该绝对授权的绝对授权值不是去激活命令时, 如果上述绝对授权的绝对 授权值不是零授权命令, 则将服务授权设置为所述绝对授权值与最小配置 服务授权值中的最大值; 或者, 如果上述绝对授权的绝对授权值为零授权 命令, 则将服务授权设置为零授权。
本实现方式中, 上 4艮模块 1001 , 具体用于向 RNC上 ^亥 UE在上行 增强专用信道操作期间支持接收标识为第一 E-RNTI的绝对授权的能力。
本实施例的另一种实现方式中, 接收模块 1002接收的配置消息携带 的 E-RNTI包括主 E-RNTI和辅 E-RNTI; 本实现方式中, 基站为 UE所属 的群组分配的 E-RNTI为辅 E-RNTI, 该辅 E-RNTI是公共的, 基站为 UE 所属群组中的所有 UE 配置相同的辅 E-RNTI。 这样, 就可以通过该辅 E-RNTI对一个群组下的所有 UE进行控制 ,进而可以实现群组的激活或去 激活进程的操作,减少了 E-AGCH的使用,提高了下行码资源的使用效率, 避免了下行吞吐量受限。
本实现方式的一种具体实现方式中, 激活 /去激活模块 1004, 具体用 于当监听模块 1003在第一信道中接收到的绝对授权的标识为辅 E-RNTI, 并且该绝对授权的绝对授权值为去激活命令时, 如果上述绝对授权的绝对 授权范围为每 HARQ进程和已配置 2毫秒 TTI ,则去激活当前 TTI对应的 HARQ进程号所对应的 HARQ进程; 或者, 如果上述绝对授权的绝对授 权范围为所有 HARQ进程和已配置 2毫秒 TTI, 则去激活所有 HARQ进 程。
本实现方式的另一种具体实现方式中, 激活 /去激活模块 1004, 具体 用于当监听模块 1003 在第一信道中接收到的绝对授权的标识为辅 E-RNTI, 并且上述绝对授权的绝对授权值不是去激活命令时, 如果上述绝 对授权的绝对授权范围为每 HARQ进程 , 则激活当前 TTI对应的 HARQ 进程号所对应的 HARQ进程; 或者,如果上述绝对授权的绝对授权范围为 所有 HARQ进程, 则激活所有 HARQ进程。
本实现方式的再一种具体实现方式中, 激活 /去激活模块 1004, 具体 用于当监听模块 1003 在第一信道中接收到的绝对授权的标识为辅 E-RNTI, 并且上述绝对授权的绝对授权值不是去激活命令时, 激活当前 TTI对应的 HARQ进程号所对应的 HARQ进程, 并去激活所有 HARQ进 程中除当前 TTI对应的 HARQ进程号所对应的 HARQ进程之外的 HARQ 进程。
本实现方式中, 上述 UE还可以包括: 第二设置模块 1007;
上述第二设置模块 1007, 用于当监听模块 1003在第一信道中接收到 的绝对授权的标识为辅 E-RNTI, 并且上述绝对授权的绝对授权值不是去 激活命令时, 如果上述绝对授权值不是零授权命令, 则将服务授权设置为 上述绝对授权值与最小配置服务授权值中的最大值; 或者, 如果上述绝对 授权值是零授权命令, 则将服务授权设置为零授权;
或者, 第二设置模块 1007 , 用于当监听模块 1003在第一信道中接收到的绝 对授权的标识为辅 E-RNTI, 并且上述绝对授权的绝对授权值不是去激活 命令时, 如果上述绝对授权的定时器处于未触发状态, 则启动该定时器; 或者, 如果上述绝对授权的定时器处于触发状态, 则重置上述定时器。
本实施例的再一种实现方式中, 接收模块 1002接收的配置消息携带 的 E-RNTI包括主 E-RNTI; 或者, 接收模块 1002接收的配置消息携带的 E-RNTI包括主 E-RNTI和辅 E-RNTI;
本实现方式中, UE还可以包括: 第二确定模块 1008;
上述第二确定模块 1008 , 用于在激活 /去激活模块 1004激活或去激活 HARQ进程之前, 当监听模块 1003在第一信道中接收到标识为主 E-RNTI 的绝对授权时, 确定标识为主 E-RNTI的绝对授权的类型为主授权。
本实现方式的一种具体实现方式中, 激活 /去激活模块 1004, 具体用 于当监听模块 1003在第一信道中接收到的绝对授权的标识为主 E-RNTI, 并且上述绝对授权的绝对授权值为去激活命令时, 如果上述绝对授权的绝 对授权范围为每 HARQ进程和已配置 2毫秒 TTI,则去激活当前 TTI对应 的 HARQ进程号所对应的 HARQ进程; 或者, 如果上述绝对授权的绝对 授权范围为所有 HARQ进程、 已配置 2毫秒 TTI和没有配置辅 E-RNTI , 则去激活所有 HARQ进程; 或者,如果上述绝对授权的绝对授权范围为所 有 HARQ进程和已配置辅 E-RNTI, 则激活所有 HARQ进程, 将服务授权 设置为储存第二授权值, 并将主授权有效性设置为假。
本实现方式的另一种具体实现方式中, 激活 /去激活模块 1004, 具体 用于当监听模块 1003 在第一信道中接收到的绝对授权的标识为主 E-RNTI, 并且上述绝对授权的绝对授权值不是去激活命令时, 如果上述绝 对授权的绝对授权范围为每 HARQ进程 ,则去激活当前 TTI对应的 HARQ 进程号所对应的 HARQ进程; 或者,如果上述绝对授权的绝对授权范围为 所有 HARQ进程, 则激活所有 HARQ进程。
本实现方式中, 上述 UE还可以包括: 第三设置模块 1009;
上述第三设置模块 1009, 用于当监听模块 1003在第一信道中接收到 的绝对授权的标识为主 E-RNTI, 并且上述绝对授权的绝对授权值不是去 激活命令时, 将主授权有效性设置为真; 或者,
第三设置模块 1009, 用于当监听模块 1003在第一信道中接收到的绝 对授权的标识为主 E-RNTI, 并且上述绝对授权的绝对授权值不是去激活 命令时, 如果上述绝对授权的定时器处于未触发状态, 则启动该定时器, 或者, 如果上述绝对授权的定时器处于触发状态, 则重置上述定时器; 或者,
第三设置模块 1009, 用于当监听模块 1003在第一信道中接收到的绝 对授权的标识为主 E-RNTI或者主授权有效性设置为假, 并且上述绝对授 权的绝对授权值不是去激活命令时, 如果上述绝对授权的绝对授权值不是 零授权命令, 则将服务授权设置为上述绝对授权值与最小配置服务授权值 中的最大值; 或者, 如果上述绝对授权的绝对授权值为零授权命令, 则将 服务授权设置为零授权。
上述实施例可以实现根据上述配置消息携带的为 UE所属群组分配的 E-RNTI对一个群组下的所有 UE进行控制 ,进而可以实现群组的激活或去 激活进程的操作,减少了 E-AGCH的使用,提高了下行码资源的使用效率, 避免了下行吞吐量受限。
图 12为本发明基站一个实施例的结构示意图, 本实施例中的基站可 以实现本发明图 2所示实施例的流程, 如图 12所示, 该基站可以包括: 接收模块 1201、 配置模块 1202和发送模块 1203;
其中, 接收模块 1201 , 用于接收 RNC发送的 UE的上行增强专用信 道配置信息;
配置模块 1202, 用于在接收模块 1201接收到 UE的上行增强专用信 道配置信息之后, 为该 UE配置 E-RNTI; 其中, 配置模块 1202为 UE配 置的 E-RNTI 可以包括配置模块 1202 为上述 UE 所属的群组分配的 E-RNTI;
发送模块 1203 , 用于将配置模块 1202为 UE配置的 E-RNTI发送给 RNC , 以及通过第一信道向 UE发送标识为配置的 E-RNTI的绝对授权。
本实施例中, 上述第一信道可以为 E-AGCH、公共 E-AGCH ( common E-AGCH ) 或非服务小区 E-AGCH ( non-serving E-AGCH ) 。
本实施例的一种实现方式中, 配置模块 1202, 具体用于为 UE配置第 一 E-RNTI和主 E-RNTI; 或者, 为 UE配置第一 E-RNTI、 主 E-RNTI和 辅 E-RNTI;本实现方式中,配置模块 1202为 UE所属的群组分配的 E-RNTI 为第一 E-RNTI,该第一 E-RNTI可以为附加的主 E-RNTK additional Primary E-RNTI ) , 也可以为组 E-RNTI ( group E-RNTI ) 。 本实现方式中, 第一 E-RNTI是公共的, 配置模块 1202为 UE所属群组中的所有 UE配置相同 的第一 E-RNTI。 这样, 就可以通过该第一 E-RNTI对一个群组下的所有 UE 进行控制, 进而可以实现群组的激活或去激活进程的操作, 减少了 E-AGCH的使用,提高了下行码资源的使用效率,避免了下行吞吐量受限。
本实现方式中,发送模块 1203用于通过第一信道向 UE发送标识为配 置的 E-RNTI的绝对授权可以为: 发送模块 1203 , 具体用于在当前控制需 求为单独控制时,通过第一信道向 UE发送标识为主 E-RNTI的绝对授权; 或者, 在当前控制需求为群组控制时, 通过第一信道向 UE发送标识为第 一 E-RNTI的绝对授权。
进一步地,发送模块 1203 ,还用于在向 UE发送标识为配置的 E-RNTI 的绝对授权之后, 当基站需要改变 UE的第一 E-RNTI时, 向 RNC发送更 新后的第一 E-RNTI, 并通知 RNC进行第一 E-RNTI的变更, 以便 RNC 将更新后的第一 E-RNTI发送给 UE。
本实施例的另一种实现方式中, 配置模块 1202, 具体用于为 UE配置 主 E-RNTI和辅 E-RNTI。 本实现方式中, 配置模块 1202为 UE所属的群 组分配的 E-RNTI为辅 E-RNTI, 该辅 E-RNTI是公共的, 配置模块 1202 为 UE所属群组中的所有 UE配置相同的辅 E-RNTI。 这样, 就可以通过该 辅 E-RNTI对一个群组下的所有 UE进行控制, 进而可以实现群组的激活 或去激活进程的操作, 减少了 E-AGCH的使用,提高了下行码资源的使用 效率, 避免了下行吞吐量受限。
本实现方式中,发送模块 1203用于通过第一信道向 UE发送标识为配 置的 E-RNTI的绝对授权可以为: 发送模块 1203 , 具体用于在当前控制需 求为单独控制时,通过第一信道向 UE发送标识为主 E-RNTI的绝对授权; 或者, 在当前控制需求为群组控制时, 通过第一信道向 UE发送标识为辅 E-RNTI的绝对授权。
进一步地,发送模块 1203 ,还用于在向 UE发送标识为配置的 E-RNTI 的绝对授权之后, 当基站需要改变 UE的辅 E-RNTI时, 向 RNC发送更新 后的辅 E-RNTI, 并通知 RNC进行辅 E-RNTI的变更, 以便 RNC将上述 更新后的辅 E-RNTI发送给 UE。
本实施例的再一种实现方式中, 配置模块 1202, 具体用于为 UE配置 主 E-RNTI; 或者, 为 UE配置主 E-RNTI和辅 E-RNTI。
进一步地,发送模块 1203 ,还用于在配置模块 1202为 UE配置 E-RNTI 之后,将配置模块 1202为 UE分配的 HARQ进程信息发送给 RNC。其中, 该 HARQ进程信息可以为允许 UE发送数据的 HARQ进程的配置信息。
进一步地, 发送模块 1203 , 还用于在将配置模块 1202为 UE分配的 HARQ进程信息发送给 RNC之后,将该 UE的进程状态信息发送给 RNC, 以便 RNC根据上述进程状态信息初始配置或者重配置 UE的进程状态。
进一步地,发送模块 1203 ,还用于在向 UE发送标识为配置的 E-RNTI 的绝对授权之后, 向 RNC发送上述 UE的进程状态信息, 这时, 接收到 该 UE的进程状态信息之后, RNC可以配置或不配置 UE的进程状态。
其中, 上述 UE的进程状态信息可以为 UE的 HARQ进程激活或去激 活状态信息、 HARQ进程的负载信息、 高低速指示消息和指示授权消息之 一或组合。
本实施例中, 接收模块 1201 , 还用于在接收到 RNC发送的 UE的上 行增强专用信道配置信息之后, 配置模块 1202为 UE配置 E-RNTI之前, 接收 RNC发送的指示消息, 该指示消息用于指示上述基站进行无线链路 建立的消息配置。 也就是说, 基站可以在接收到 RNC发送的该指示消息 之后 , 再为 UE配置 E-RNTI。
本实施例中, 配置模块 1202, 具体用于根据当前控制参考信息为 UE 配置 E-RNTI; 其中, 上述当前控制参考信息包括: 上述 UE的速率、 上述 UE的数据块、 上述 UE被分配的进程号、 上述 UE对应的分组信息和当前 小区进程使用情况之一或组合。
上述实施例中, 接收模块 1201接收到 RNC发送的 UE的上行增强专 用信道配置信息之后, 配置模块 1202为该 UE配置 E-RNTI; 然后发送模 块 1203将为上述 UE配置的 E-RNTI发送给 RNC, 由 RNC将基站为该 UE配置的 E-RNTI发送给 UE , 其中, 基站为该 UE配置的 E-RNTI可以 包括基站为上述 UE所属的群组分配的 E-RNTI;从而可以实现根据基站为 上述 UE所属的群组分配的 E-RNTI对一个群组下的所有 UE进行控制, 进而可以实现群组的激活或去激活进程的操作, 减少了 E-AGCH的使用, 提高了下行码资源的使用效率, 避免了下行吞吐量受限。
图 13 为本发明无线网络控制器一个实施例的结构示意图, 本实施例 中的 RNC可以实现本发明图 3所示实施例的流程,如图 13所示, 该 RNC 可以包括: 接收模块 1301和发送模块 1302;
其中, 接收模块 1301 , 用于接收 UE上报的该 UE支持上行增强专用 信道的能力;以及在发送模块 1302将上述 UE的上行增强专用信道配置信 息发送给基站之后, 接收基站发送的该基站为 UE配置的 E-RNTI; 其中, 该基站为 UE配置的 E-RNTI可以包括基站为上述 UE所属的群组分配的 E-RNTI;
发送模块 1302 ,用于将 UE的上行增强专用信道配置信息发送给基站; 以及在接收模块 1301接收基站发送的该基站为 UE配置的 E-RNTI之后, 将基站为 UE配置的 E-RNTI发送给 UE , 以便 UE釆用配置的 E-RNTI监 听第一信道, 并根据在第一信道中接收到的绝对授权激活或去激活 HARQ 进程。
本实施例中,接收模块 1301接收到 UE上报的该 UE支持上行增强专 用信道的能力之后 ,发送模块 1302将该 UE的上行增强专用信道配置信息 发送给基站。 其中, 该 UE的上行增强专用信道配置信息包括该 UE支持 的上行增强专用信道的帧偏移量等信息。
本实施例中, 上述第一信道可以为 E-AGCH、公共 E-AGCH ( common E-AGCH ) 或非服务小区 E-AGCH ( non-serving E-AGCH ) 。
本实施例的一种实现方式中,接收模块 1301接收的基站为 UE配置的 E-RNTI包括第一 E-RNTI和主 E-RNTI; 或者,接收模块 1301接收的基站 为 UE配置的 E-RNTI包括第一 E-RNTI、 主 E-RNTI和辅 E-RNTI。 本实 现方式中, 基站为 UE所属的群组分配的 E-RNTI为第一 E-RNTI, 该第一 E-RNTI可以为附加的主 E-RNTI ( additional Primary E-RNTI ) , 也可以为 组 E-RNTI ( group E-RNTI ) 。 本实现方式中, 第一 E-RNTI是公共的, 基 站为 UE所属群组中的所有 UE配置相同的第一 E-RNTI。 这样, 就可以通 过该第一 E-RNTI对一个群组下的所有 UE进行控制 , 进而可以实现群组 的激活或去激活进程的操作, 减少了 E-AGCH的使用,提高了下行码资源 的使用效率, 避免了下行吞吐量受限。
进一步地, 接收模块 1301 , 还用于在发送模块 1302将基站为 UE配 置的 E-RNTI发送给 UE之后, 接收基站发送的更新后的第一 E-RNTI , 以 及接收基站发送的进行第一 E-RNTI的变更的通知;
发送模块 1302 ,还用于将接收模块 1301接收的更新后的第一 E-RNTI 发送给 UE。
本实施例的另一种实现方式中,接收模块 1301接收的基站为 UE配置 的 E-RNTI包括主 E-RNTI和辅 E-RNTI。 本实现方式中, 基站为 UE所属 的群组分配的 E-RNTI为辅 E-RNTI, 该辅 E-RNTI是公共的, 基站为 UE 所属群组中的所有 UE 配置相同的辅 E-RNTI。 这样, 就可以通过该辅 E-RNTI对一个群组下的所有 UE进行控制 ,进而可以实现群组的激活或去 激活进程的操作,减少了 E-AGCH的使用,提高了下行码资源的使用效率, 避免了下行吞吐量受限。
进一步地, 接收模块 1301 , 还用于在发送模块 1302将基站为 UE配 置的 E-RNTI发送给 UE之后 , 接收基站发送的更新后的辅 E-RNTI, 以及 接收基站发送的进行辅 E-RNTI的变更的通知;
发送模块 1302 , 还用于将接收模块 1301接收的更新后的辅 E-RNTI 发送给 UE。
本实施例的再一种实现方式中,接收模块 1301接收的基站为 UE配置 的 E-RNTI包括主 E-RNTI; 或者, 接收模块 1301接收的基站为 UE配置 的 E-RNTI包括主 E-RNTI和辅 E-RNTL
进一步地, 接收模块 1301 , 还用于在发送模块 1302将 UE的上行增 强专用信道配置信息发送给基站之后,接收基站为 UE分配的 HARQ进程 信息。 其中, 该 HARQ进程信息可以为允许 UE发送数据的 HARQ进程 的配置信息。
可选地, 上述 RNC还可以进一步包括: 配置模块 1303 ;
接收模块 1301 , 还用于在接收基站为 UE分配的 HARQ进程信息之 后, 接收基站发送的该 UE的进程状态信息; 配置模块 1303 , 用于根据接收模块 1301接收的进程状态信息初始配 置或者重配置 UE的进程状态。
本实施例中, 接收模块 1301 , 还用于在发送模块 1302将基站为 UE 配置的 E-RNTI发送给 UE之后, 接收基站发送的上述 UE的进程状态信 息, 这时, 接收到该 UE 的进程状态信息之后, RNC 可以配置或不配置 UE的进程状态。
其中, 上述 UE的进程状态信息可以为 UE的 HARQ进程激活或去激 活状态信息、 HARQ进程的负载信息、 高低速指示消息和指示授权消息之 一或组合。
发送模块 1302,还用于在将 UE的上行增强专用信道配置信息发送给 基站之后,接收模块 1301接收基站发送的该基站为 UE配置的 E-RNTI之 前, 向基站发送指示消息, 上述指示消息用于指示基站进行无线链路建立 的消息配置。 也就是说, 基站可以在接收到 RNC发送的该指示消息之后, 再为 UE配置 E-RNTL
上述实施例中,接收模块 1301接收 UE上报的该 UE支持上行增强专 用信道的能力之后,发送模块 1302将上述 UE的上行增强专用信道配置信 息发送给基站,然后接收模块 1301接收基站发送的该基站为上述 UE配置 的 E-RNTI, 并由发送模块 1302将基站为上述 UE配置的 E-RNTI发送给 UE, 其中, 该基站为上述 UE配置的 E-RNTI可以包括基站为 UE所属的 群组分配的 E-RNTI;从而可以实现根据上述基站为 UE所属的群组分配的 E-RNTI对一个群组下的所有 UE进行控制 ,进而可以实现群组的激活或去 激活进程的操作,减少了 E-AGCH的使用,提高了下行码资源的使用效率, 避免了下行吞吐量受限。
图 14为本发明用户设备再一个实施例的结构示意图, 本实施例中的 UE可以实现本发明图 1所示实施例的流程, 如图 14所示, 该 UE可以包 括: 发送器 1401、 接收器 1402和处理器 1403;
其中, 发送器 1401 , 用于向 RNC上报该 UE支持上行增强专用信道 的能力;
接收器 1402 , 用于接收 RNC 发送的配置消息, 该配置消息携带 E-RNTI; 其中, 该配置消息携带的 E-RNTI可以包括为 UE所属的群组分 配的 E-RNTI;
处理器 1403 , 用于釆用接收器 1402接收的配置消息携带的 E-RNTI 监听第一信道, 以及根据在第一信道中接收到的绝对授权激活或去激活 HARQ进程。
本实施例中, 上述第一信道可以为 E-AGCH、公共 E-AGCH ( common
E-AGCH ) 或非服务小区 E-AGCH ( non-serving E-AGCH ) 。
本实施例中,上述绝对授权包括 UE的 HARQ进程的激活或去激活指 示, 上述 UE的 HARQ进程的激活指示为具体的授权值。
本实施例的一种实现方式中, 接收器 1402 接收的配置消息携带的 E-RNTI包括第一 E-RNTI和主 E-RNTI; 或者,接收器 1402接收的配置消 息携带的 E-RNTI包括第一 E-RNTI、 主 E-RNTI和辅 E-RNTI。 本实现方 式中, 为上述 UE所属的群组分配的 E-RNTI为第一 E-RNTI, 上述第一 E-RNTI可以为附加的主 E-RNTI ( additional Primary E-RNTI ) , 也可以为 组 E-RNTI ( group E-RNTI ) ; 本实现方式中, 第一 E-RNTI是公共的, 基 站为 UE所属群组中的所有 UE配置相同的第一 E-RNTI。 这样 , 就可以通 过该第一 E-RNTI对一个群组下的所有 UE进行控制, 进而可以实现群组 的激活或去激活进程的操作, 减少了 E-AGCH的使用,提高了下行码资源 的使用效率, 避免了下行吞吐量受限。
本实现方式中, 处理器 1403 , 还用于在激活或去激活 HARQ进程之 前, 当在第一信道中接收到标识为第一 E-RNTI或主 E-RNTI的绝对授权 时, 确定标识为第 ― E-RNTI或主 E-RNTI的绝对授权的类型为主授权。
本实现方式的一种具体实现方式中, 处理器 1403 用于根据在第一信 道中接收到的绝对授权激活或去激活 HARQ进程可以为:
处理器 1403 ,具体用于当在第一信道中接收到的绝对授权的标识为第 一 E-RNTI, 并且该绝对授权的绝对授权值为去激活命令时, 如果上述绝 对授权的绝对授权范围为每 HARQ进程和已配置 2毫秒 TTI,则去激活当 前 TTI对应的 HARQ进程号所对应的 HARQ进程; 或者, 如果上述绝对 授权的绝对授权范围为所有 HARQ进程、 已配置 2毫秒 TTI并且未配置 辅 E-RNTI , 则去激活所有 HARQ进程; 或者, 如果上述绝对授权的绝对 授权范围为所有 HARQ进程和已配置辅 E-RNTI,则激活所有 HARQ进程, 将服务授权设置为储存第二授权值, 并将主授权有效性设置为假。
本实现方式的另一种具体实现方式中, 处理器 1403 用于根据在第一 信道中接收到的绝对授权激活或去激活 HARQ进程可以为:
处理器 1403 ,具体用于当在第一信道中接收到的绝对授权的标识为第 一 E-RNTI, 并且上述绝对授权的绝对授权值不是去激活命令时, 如果上 述绝对授权的绝对授权范围为每 HARQ 进程, 则激活当前 TTI 对应的 HARQ进程号所对应的 HARQ进程; 或者, 如果上述绝对授权的绝对授 权范围为所有 HARQ进程, 则激活所有 HARQ进程。
本实现方式的另一种具体实现方式中, 处理器 1403 用于根据在第一 信道中接收到的绝对授权激活或去激活 HARQ进程可以为:
处理器 1403 ,具体用于当在第一信道中接收到的绝对授权的标识为第 一 E-RNTI, 并且上述绝对授权的绝对授权值不是去激活命令时, 激活当 前 TTI对应的 HARQ进程号所对应的 HARQ进程, 并去激活所有 HARQ 进程。
本实现方式的再一种具体实现方式中, 处理器 1403 ,还用于当在第一 信道中接收到的绝对授权的标识为第一 E-RNTI, 并且上述绝对授权的绝 对授权值不是去激活命令时, 将主授权有效性设置为真。
本实现方式的再一种具体实现方式, 处理器 1403 ,还用于当在第一信 道中接收到的绝对授权的标识为第一 E-RNTI, 并且上述绝对授权的绝对 授权值不是去激活命令时, 如果上述绝对授权的定时器处于未触发状态, 则启动该定时器, 或者, 如果上述绝对授权的定时器处于触发状态, 则重 置该定时器。
本实现方式的再一种具体实现方式, 处理器 1403 ,还用于当在第一信 道中接收到的绝对授权的标识为第一 E-RNTI、主 E-RNTI或者主授权有效 性设置为假, 并且上述绝对授权的绝对授权值不是去激活命令时, 如果上 述绝对授权的绝对授权值不是零授权命令, 则将服务授权设置为所述绝对 授权值与最小配置服务授权值中的最大值; 或者, 如果上述绝对授权的绝 对授权值为零授权命令, 则将服务授权设置为零授权。
本实现方式中, 发送器 1401 , 具体用于向 RNC上 ^亥 UE在上行增 强专用信道操作期间支持接收标识为第一 E-RNTI的绝对授权的能力。 本实施例的另一种实现方式中, 接收器 1402接收的配置消息携带的
E-RNTI包括主 E-RNTI和辅 E-RNTI; 本实现方式中, 基站为 UE所属的 群组分配的 E-RNTI为辅 E-RNTI, 该辅 E-RNTI是公共的, 基站为 UE所 属群组中的所有 UE配置相同的辅 E-RNTI。这样 ,就可以通过该辅 E-RNTI 对一个群组下的所有 UE进行控制, 进而可以实现群组的激活或去激活进 程的操作, 减少了 E-AGCH的使用, 提高了下行码资源的使用效率, 避免 了下行吞吐量受限。
本实现方式的一种具体实现方式中, 处理器 1403 用于根据在第一信 道中接收到的绝对授权激活或去激活 HARQ进程可以为: 处理器 1403 , 具体用于当在第一信道中接收到的绝对授权的标识为辅 E-RNTI, 并且上 述绝对授权的绝对授权值为去激活命令时, 如果上述绝对授权的绝对授权 范围为每 HARQ进程和已配置 2毫秒 TTI ,则去激活当前 TTI对应的 HARQ 进程号所对应的 HARQ进程; 或者,如果上述绝对授权的绝对授权范围为 所有 HARQ进程和已配置 2毫秒 TTI, 则去激活所有 HARQ进程。
本实现方式的一种具体实现方式中, 处理器 1403 用于根据在第一信 道中接收到的绝对授权激活或去激活 HARQ进程可以为:
处理器 1403 ,具体用于当在第一信道中接收到的绝对授权的标识为辅 E-RNTI, 并且上述绝对授权的绝对授权值不是去激活命令时, 如果上述绝 对授权的绝对授权范围为每 HARQ进程 , 则激活当前 TTI对应的 HARQ 进程号所对应的 HARQ进程; 或者,如果上述绝对授权的绝对授权范围为 所有 HARQ进程, 则激活所有 HARQ进程。
本实现方式的一种具体实现方式中, 处理器 1403 用于根据在第一信 道中接收到的绝对授权激活或去激活 HARQ进程可以为:
处理器 1403 ,具体用于当在第一信道中接收到的绝对授权的标识为辅
E-RNTI, 并且上述绝对授权的绝对授权值不是去激活命令时, 激活当前 TTI对应的 HARQ进程号所对应的 HARQ进程, 并去激活所有 HARQ进 程中除当前 TTI对应的 HARQ进程号所对应的 HARQ进程之外的 HARQ 进程。
进一步地, 本实现方式的再一种具体实现方式中, 处理器 1403 , 还用 于当在第一信道中接收到的绝对授权的标识为辅 E-RNTI, 并且上述绝对 授权的绝对授权值不是去激活命令时, 如果上述绝对授权值不是零授权命 令, 则将服务授权设置为所述绝对授权值与最小配置服务授权值中的最大 值; 或者, 如果上述绝对授权值是零授权命令, 则将服务授权设置为零授 权。
本实现方式的再一种具体实现方式中, 处理器 1403 ,还用于当在第一 信道中接收到的绝对授权的标识为辅 E-RNTI, 并且上述绝对授权的绝对 授权值不是去激活命令时, 如果上述绝对授权的定时器处于未触发状态, 则启动定时器; 或者, 如果上述绝对授权的定时器处于触发状态时, 则重 置定时器。
本实施例的再一种实现方式中, 接收器 1402接收的配置消息携带的 E-RNTI包括主 E-RNTI;或者,接收器 1402接收的配置消息携带的 E-RNTI 包括主 E-RNTI和辅 E-RNTI;
本实现方式中, 处理器 1403 , 还用于在激活或去激活 HARQ进程之 前, 当在第一信道中接收到标识为主 E-RNTI的绝对授权时, 确定标识为 主 E-RNTI的绝对授权的类型为主授权。
本实现方式的一种具体实现方式中, 处理器 1403 用于根据在第一信 道中接收到的绝对授权激活或去激活 HARQ进程可以为:
处理器 1403 ,具体用于当在第一信道中接收到的绝对授权的标识为主 E-RNTI, 并且上述绝对授权的绝对授权值为去激活命令时, 如果上述绝对 授权的绝对授权范围为每 HARQ进程和已配置 2毫秒 TTI ,则去激活当前 TTI对应的 HARQ进程号所对应的 HARQ进程; 或者, 如果上述绝对授 权的绝对授权范围为所有 HARQ进程、 已配置 2毫秒 TTI和没有配置辅 E-RNTI, 则去激活所有 HARQ进程; 或者, 如果上述绝对授权的绝对授 权范围为所有 HARQ进程和已配置辅 E-RNTI , 则激活所有 HARQ进程 , 将服务授权设置为储存第二授权值, 并将主授权有效性设置为假。
本实现方式的另一种具体实现方式中, 处理器 1403 用于根据在第一 信道中接收到的绝对授权激活或去激活 HARQ进程可以为:
处理器 1403 ,具体用于当在第一信道中接收到的绝对授权的标识为主 E-RNTI, 并且上述绝对授权的绝对授权值不是去激活命令时, 如果上述绝 对授权的绝对授权范围为每 HARQ进程,则去激活当前 TTI对应的 HARQ 进程号所对应的 HARQ进程; 或者,如果上述绝对授权的绝对授权范围为 所有 HARQ进程, 则激活所有 HARQ进程。
进一步地, 本实现方式的再一种具体实现方式中, 处理器 1403 , 还用 于当在第一信道中接收到的绝对授权的标识为主 E-RNTI, 并且上述绝对 授权的绝对授权值不是去激活命令时, 将主授权有效性设置为真。
本实现方式的再一种具体实现方式中, 处理器 1403 ,还用于当在第一 信道中接收到的绝对授权的标识为主 E-RNTI, 并且上述绝对授权的绝对 授权值不是去激活命令时, 如果上述绝对授权的定时器处于未触发状态, 则启动上述定时器; 或者, 如果上述绝对授权的定时器处于触发状态, 则 重置上述定时器。
本实现方式的再一种具体实现方式中, 处理器 1403 ,还用于当在第一 信道中接收到的绝对授权的标识为主 E-RNTI 或者主授权有效性设置为 假, 并且上述绝对授权的绝对授权值不是去激活命令时, 如果上述绝对授 权的绝对授权值不是零授权命令, 则将服务授权设置为所述绝对授权值与 最小配置服务授权值中的最大值; 或者, 如果上述绝对授权的绝对授权值 为零授权命令, 则将服务授权设置为零授权。
上述实施例中, 发送器 1401向 RNC上报该 UE支持上行增强专用信 道的能力,接收器 1402接收上述 RNC发送的配置消息, 然后处理器 1403 釆用上述配置消息携带的 E-RNTI监听第一信道, 其中, 该配置消息携带 的 E-RNTI可以包括为 UE所属的群组分配的 E-RNTI; 然后,处理器 1403 根据在第一信道中接收到的绝对授权激活或去激活 HARQ进程。从而可以 实现根据上述配置消息携带的为 UE所属的群组分配的 E-RNTI对一个群 组下的所有 UE进行控制,进而可以实现群组的激活或去激活进程的操作, 减少了 E-AGCH的使用, 提高了下行码资源的使用效率, 避免了下行吞吐 量受限。
图 15 为本发明基站另一个实施例的结构示意图, 本实施例中的基站 可以实现本发明图 2所示实施例的流程, 如图 15所示, 该基站可以包括: 接收器 1501、 处理器 1502和发送器 1503;
接收器 1501 , 用于接收 RNC发送的 UE的上行增强专用信道配置信 息;
处理器 1502, 用于在接收器 1501接收到 UE的上行增强专用信道配 置信息之后,为该 UE配置 E-RNTI;其中,处理器 1502为 UE配置的 E-RNTI 可以包括处理器 1502为上述 UE所属的群组分配的 E-RNTI;
发送器 1503 ,用于将处理器 1502为 UE配置的 E-RNTI发送给 RNC, 以及通过第一信道向 UE发送标识为配置的 E-RNTI的绝对授权。
本实施例中, 上述第一信道可以为 E-AGCH、公共 E-AGCH ( common E-AGCH ) 或非服务小区 E-AGCH ( non-serving E-AGCH ) 。
本实施例的一种实现方式中, 处理器 1502, 具体用于为 UE配置第一 E-RNTI和主 E-RNTI; 或者, 为 UE配置第一 E-RNTI、 主 E-RNTI和辅 E-RNTI; 本实现方式中, 处理器 1502为 UE所属的群组分配的 E-RNTI 为第一 E-RNTI,该第一 E-RNTI可以为附加的主 E-RNTK additional Primary E-RNTI ) , 也可以为组 E-RNTI ( group E-RNTI ) 。 本实现方式中, 第一 E-RNTI是公共的, 处理器 1502为 UE所属群组中的所有 UE配置相同的 第一 E-RNTI。 这样, 就可以通过该第一 E-RNTI对一个群组下的所有 UE 进行控制, 进而可以实现群组的激活或去激活进程的操作, 减少了 E-AGCH的使用,提高了下行码资源的使用效率,避免了下行吞吐量受限。
本实现方式中,发送器 1503用于通过第一信道向 UE发送标识为配置 的 E-RNTI的绝对授权可以为: 发送器 1503 , 具体用于在当前控制需求为 单独控制时, 通过第一信道向 UE发送标识为主 E-RNTI的绝对授权; 或 者, 在当前控制需求为群组控制时, 通过第一信道向 UE发送标识为第一 E-RNTI的绝对授权。
进一步地, 发送器 1503 , 还用于在向 UE发送标识为配置的 E-RNTI 的绝对授权之后, 当基站需要改变 UE的第一 E-RNTI时, 向 RNC发送更 新后的第一 E-RNTI, 并通知 RNC进行第一 E-RNTI的变更, 以便 RNC 将更新后的第一 E-RNTI发送给 UE。
本实施例的另一种实现方式中, 处理器 1502, 具体用于为 UE配置主 E-RNTI和辅 E-RNTI。 本实现方式中, 处理器 1502为 UE所属的群组分 配的 E-RNTI为辅 E-RNTI, 该辅 E-RNTI是公共的, 处理器 1502为 UE 所属群组中的所有 UE 配置相同的辅 E-RNTI。 这样, 就可以通过该辅 E-RNTI对一个群组下的所有 UE进行控制 ,进而可以实现群组的激活或去 激活进程的操作,减少了 E-AGCH的使用,提高了下行码资源的使用效率, 避免了下行吞吐量受限。
本实现方式中,发送器 1503用于通过第一信道向 UE发送标识为配置 的 E-RNTI的绝对授权可以为: 发送器 1503 , 具体用于在当前控制需求为 单独控制时, 通过第一信道向 UE发送标识为主 E-RNTI的绝对授权; 或 者, 在当前控制需求为群组控制时, 通过第一信道向 UE 发送标识为辅 E-RNTI的绝对授权。
进一步地, 发送器 1503 , 还用于在向 UE发送标识为配置的 E-RNTI 的绝对授权之后, 当基站需要改变 UE的辅 E-RNTI时, 向 RNC发送更新 后的辅 E-RNTI, 并通知 RNC进行辅 E-RNTI的变更, 以便 RNC将更新 后的辅 E-RNTI发送给 UE。
本实施例的再一种实现方式中, 处理器 1502, 具体用于为 UE配置主 E-RNTI; 或者, 为 UE配置主 E-RNTI和辅 E-RNTI。
进一步地, 发送器 1503 , 还用于在处理器 1502为 UE配置 E-RNTI 之后, 将处理器 1502为 UE分配的 HARQ进程信息发送给 RNC。 其中, 该 HARQ进程信息可以为允许 UE发送数据的 HARQ进程的配置信息。
进一步地,发送器 1503 ,还用于在将处理器 1502为 UE分配的 HARQ 进程信息发送给 RNC之后,将 UE的进程状态信息发送给 RNC,以便 RNC 根据上述进程状态信息初始配置或者重配置 UE的进程状态。
进一步地, 发送器 1503 , 还用于在向 UE发送标识为配置的 E-RNTI 的绝对授权之后, 向 RNC发送上述 UE的进程状态信息, 这时, 接收到 该 UE的进程状态信息之后, RNC可以配置或不配置 UE的进程状态。
其中, 上述 UE的进程状态信息可以为 UE的 HARQ进程激活或去激 活状态信息、 HARQ进程的负载信息、 高低速指示消息和指示授权消息之 一或组合。
进一步地, 接收器 1501 , 还用于在接收到 RNC发送的 UE的上行增 强专用信道配置信息之后, 处理器 1502为 UE配置 E-RNTI之前, 接收 RNC发送的指示消息,上述指示消息用于指示基站进行无线链路建立的消 息配置。 也就是说, 基站可以在接收到 RNC发送的该指示消息之后, 再 为 UE配置 E-RNTI。
本实施例中, 处理器 1502, 具体用于根据当前控制参考信息为 UE配 置 E-RNTI; 其中, 上述当前控制参考信息包括: 上述 UE 的速率、 上述 UE的数据块、 上述 UE被分配的进程号、 上述 UE对应的分组信息和当前 小区进程使用情况之一或组合。
上述实施例中, 接收器 1501接收到 RNC发送的 UE的上行增强专用 信道配置信息之后, 处理器 1502为该 UE配置 E-RNTI; 然后发送器 1503 将为上述 UE配置的 E-RNTI发送给 RNC ,由 RNC将基站为该 UE配置的 E-RNTI发送给 UE , 其中, 基站为该 UE配置的 E-RNTI可以包括基站为 上述 UE所属的群组分配的 E-RNTI。从而可以实现根据基站为上述 UE所 属的群组分配的 E-RNTI对一个群组下的所有 UE进行控制, 进而可以实 现群组的激活或去激活进程的操作, 减少了 E-AGCH的使用,提高了下行 码资源的使用效率, 避免了下行吞吐量受限。
图 16为本发明无线网络控制器另一个实施例的结构示意图, 本实施 例中的 RNC 可以实现本发明图 3 所示实施例的流程, 如图 16所示, 该 RNC可以包括: 接收器 1601和发送器 1602;
接收器 1601 , 用于接收 UE上报的该 UE支持上行增强专用信道的能 力;以及在发送器 1602将 UE的上行增强专用信道配置信息发送给基站之 后, 接收基站发送的该基站为 UE配置的 E-RNTI; 其中, 该基站为 UE配 置的 E-RNTI可以包括基站为上述 UE所属的群组分配的 E-RNTI;
发送器 1602, 用于将 UE的上行增强专用信道配置信息发送给基站; 以及在接收器 1601接收上述基站发送的该基站为 UE配置的 E-RNTI之后, 将上述基站为 UE配置的 E-RNTI发送给 UE,以便 UE釆用配置的 E-RNTI 监听第一信道, 并根据在第一信道中接收到的绝对授权激活或去激活 HARQ进程。
本实施例中,接收器 1601接收到 UE上报的该 UE支持上行增强专用 信道的能力之后,发送器 1602将该 UE的上行增强专用信道配置信息发送 给基站。 其中, 该 UE的上行增强专用信道配置信息包括该 UE支持的上 行增强专用信道的帧偏移量等信息。
本实施例中, 上述第一信道可以为 E-AGCH、公共 E-AGCH ( common E-AGCH ) 或非服务小区 E-AGCH ( non-serving E-AGCH ) 。
本实施例的一种实现方式中, 接收器 1601接收的基站为 UE配置的 E-RNTI包括第一 E-RNTI和主 E-RNTI; 或者,接收器 1601接收的基站为 UE配置的 E-RNTI包括第一 E-RNTI、 主 E-RNTI和辅 E-RNTI。 本实现方 式中, 基站为 UE 所属的群组分配的 E-RNTI 为第一 E-RNTI, 该第一 E-RNTI可以为附加的主 E-RNTI ( additional Primary E-RNTI ) , 也可以为 组 E-RNTI ( group E-RNTI ) 。 本实现方式中, 第一 E-RNTI是公共的, 基 站为 UE所属群组中的所有 UE配置相同的第一 E-RNTI。 这样, 就可以通 过该第一 E-RNTI对一个群组下的所有 UE进行控制, 进而可以实现群组 的激活或去激活进程的操作, 减少了 E-AGCH的使用,提高了下行码资源 的使用效率, 避免了下行吞吐量受限。
进一步地, 接收器 1601 , 还用于在发送器 1602将基站为 UE配置的 E-RNTI发送给 UE之后, 接收基站发送的更新后的第一 E-RNTI, 以及接 收基站发送的进行第一 E-RNTI的变更的通知;
发送器 1602, 还用于将接收器 1601接收的更新后的第一 E-RNTI发 送给 UE。
本实施例的一种实现方式中, 接收器 1601接收的基站为 UE配置的 E-RNTI包括主 E-RNTI和辅 E-RNTI。 本实现方式中, 基站为 UE所属的 群组分配的 E-RNTI为辅 E-RNTI, 该辅 E-RNTI是公共的, 基站为 UE所 属群组中的所有 UE配置相同的辅 E-RNTI。这样 ,就可以通过该辅 E-RNTI 对一个群组下的所有 UE进行控制, 进而可以实现群组的激活或去激活进 程的操作, 减少了 E-AGCH的使用, 提高了下行码资源的使用效率, 避免 了下行吞吐量受限。
进一步地, 接收器 1601 , 还用于在发送器 1602将基站为 UE配置的 E-RNTI发送给 UE之后, 接收基站发送的更新后的辅 E-RNTI, 以及接收 基站发送的进行辅 E-RNTI的变更的通知;
发送器 1602, 还用于将接收器 1601接收的更新后的辅 E-RNTI发送 给 UE。
本实施例的再一种实现方式中,接收器 1601接收的基站为 UE配置的 E-RNTI 包括主 E-RNTI; 或者, 接收器 1601 接收的基站为 UE 配置的 E-RNTI包括主 E-RNTI和辅 E-RNTI。
进一步地, 接收器 1601 , 还用于在发送器 1602将 UE的上行增强专 用信道配置信息发送给基站之后,接收基站为该 UE分配的 HARQ进程信 息。 其中, 该 HARQ进程信息可以为允许 UE发送数据的 HARQ进程的 配置信息。
可选地, 上述 RNC还可以进一步包括: 处理器 1603;
接收器 1601 , 还用于在接收基站为 UE分配的 HARQ进程信息之后, 接收基站发送的该 UE的进程状态信息;
处理器 1603 , 用于根据接收器 1601接收的进程状态信息初始配置或 者重配置 UE的进程状态。
本实施例中, 接收器 1601 , 还用于在发送器 1602将基站为 UE配置 的 E-RNTI发送给 UE之后, 接收基站发送的上述 UE的进程状态信息, 这时, 接收到该 UE的进程状态信息之后, RNC可以配置或不配置 UE的 进程状态。
其中, 上述 UE的进程状态信息可以为 UE的 HARQ进程激活或去激 活状态信息、 HARQ进程的负载信息、 高低速指示消息和指示授权消息之 一或组合。
发送器 1602,还用于在将 UE的上行增强专用信道配置信息发送给基 站之后, 接收器 1601接收基站发送的该基站为 UE配置的 E-RNTI之前, 向基站发送指示消息, 上述指示消息用于指示基站进行无线链路建立的消 息配置。 也就是说, 基站可以在接收到 RNC发送的该指示消息之后, 再 为 UE配置 E-RNTI。
上述实施例中,接收器 1601接收 UE上报的该 UE支持上行增强专用 信道的能力之后,发送器 1602将上述 UE的上行增强专用信道配置信息发 送给基站, 然后接收器 1601 接收基站发送的该基站为上述 UE 配置的 E-RNTI, 并由发送器 1602将基站为上述 UE配置的 E-RNTI发送给 UE, 其中, 该基站为上述 UE配置的 E-RNTI可以包括基站为 UE所属的群组 分配的 E-RNTI; 从而可以实现根据上述基站为 UE 所属的群组分配的 E-RNTI对一个群组下的所有 UE进行控制 ,进而可以实现群组的激活或去 激活进程的操作,减少了 E-AGCH的使用,提高了下行码资源的使用效率, 避免了下行吞吐量受限。
本领域技术人员可以理解附图只是一个优选实施例的示意图, 附图中 的模块或流程并不一定是实施本发明所必须的。
本领域技术人员可以理解实施例中的装置中的模块可以按照实施例 描述进行分布于实施例的装置中, 也可以进行相应变化位于不同于本实施 例的一个或多个装置中。 上述实施例的模块可以合并为一个模块, 也可以 进一步拆分成多个子模块。
最后应说明的是: 以上实施例仅用以说明本发明的技术方案, 而非对 其限制; 尽管参照前述实施例对本发明进行了详细的说明, 本领域的普通 技术人员应当理解: 其依然可以对前述各实施例所记载的技术方案进行修 改, 或者对其中部分技术特征进行等同替换; 而这些修改或者替换, 并不 使相应技术方案的本质脱离本发明各实施例技术方案的范围。

Claims

权 利 要 求 书
1、 一种组调度授权的方法, 其特征在于, 包括:
用户设备向无线网络控制器上报所述用户设备支持上行增强专用信 道的能力;
所述用户设备接收所述无线网络控制器发送的配置消息, 所述配置消 息携带增强专用信道无线网络临时标识 E-RNTI; 所述配置消息携带的 E-RNTI包括为所述用户设备所属的群组分配的 E-RNTI;
所述用户设备釆用所述配置消息携带的 E-RNTI监听第一信道, 并根 据所述用户设备在所述第一信道中接收到的绝对授权激活或去激活混合 自动重传请求 HARQ进程。
2、 根据权利要求 1 所述的方法, 其特征在于, 所述配置消息携带的 E-RNTI包括第一 E-RNTI和主 E-RNTI;
所述为所述用户设备所属的群组分配的 E-RNTI为所述第一 E-RNTI。
3、 根据权利要求 2所述的方法, 其特征在于, 所述根据所述用户设 备在所述第一信道中接收到的绝对授权激活或去激活混合自动重传请求
HARQ进程之前, 还包括:
当所述用户设备在所述第一信道中接收到标识为第一 E-RNTI 或主
E-RNTI的绝对授权时 ,所述用户设备确定标识为第一 E-RNTI或主 E-RNTI 的绝对授权的类型为主授权。
4、 根据权利要求 2或 3所述的方法, 其特征在于, 所述根据所述用 户设备在所述第一信道中接收到的绝对授权激活或去激活混合自动重传 请求 HARQ进程包括:
如果所述用户设备在所述第一信道中接收到的绝对授权的标识为第 一 E-RNTI, 并且所述绝对授权的绝对授权值为去激活命令, 则当所述绝 对授权的绝对授权范围为每 HARQ进程和已配置 2毫秒传输时间间隔 TTI 时 , 所述用户设备去激活当前 TTI对应的 HARQ进程号所对应的 HARQ 进程; 或者, 当所述绝对授权的绝对授权范围为所有 HARQ进程、 已配置
2毫秒 TTI并且未配置辅 E-RNTI时, 所述用户设备去激活所有 HARQ进 程; 或者, 当所述绝对授权的绝对授权范围为所有 HARQ进程和已配置辅 E-RNTI时, 所述用户设备激活所有 HARQ进程, 将服务授权设置为储存 第二授权值, 并将主授权有效性设置为假。
5、 根据权利要求 2或 3所述的方法, 其特征在于, 所述根据所述用 户设备在所述第一信道中接收到的绝对授权激活或去激活混合自动重传 请求 HARQ进程包括:
如果所述用户设备在所述第一信道中接收到的绝对授权的标识为第 一 E-RNTI, 并且所述绝对授权的绝对授权值不是去激活命令, 则当所述 绝对授权的绝对授权范围为每 HARQ进程时,所述用户设备激活当前 TTI 对应的 HARQ进程号所对应的 HARQ进程; 或者, 当所述绝对授权的绝 对授权范围为所有 HARQ进程时, 所述用户设备激活所有 HARQ进程。
6、 根据权利要求 2或 3所述的方法, 其特征在于, 所述根据所述用 户设备在所述第一信道中接收到的绝对授权激活或去激活混合自动重传 请求 HARQ进程包括:
如果所述用户设备在所述第一信道中接收到的绝对授权的标识为第 一 E-RNTI, 并且所述绝对授权的绝对授权值不是去激活命令, 则所述用 户设备激活当前 TTI对应的 HARQ进程号所对应的 HARQ进程, 并去激 活所有 HARQ进程中除当前 TTI对应的 HARQ进程号所对应的 HARQ进 程之外的 HARQ进程。
7、 根据权利要求 2或 3所述的方法, 其特征在于, 还包括: 如果所述用户设备在所述第一信道中接收到的绝对授权的标识为第 一 E-RNTI, 并且所述绝对授权的绝对授权值不是去激活命令, 则所述用 户设备将主授权有效性设置为真; 或者,
如果所述用户设备在所述第一信道中接收到的绝对授权的标识为第 一 E-RNTI, 并且所述绝对授权的绝对授权值不是去激活命令, 则当所述 绝对授权的定时器处于未触发状态时, 所述用户设备启动所述定时器, 或 者, 当所述绝对授权的定时器处于触发状态时, 所述用户设备重置所述定 时器。
8、 根据权利要求 2或 3所述的方法, 其特征在于, 还包括: 如果所述用户设备在所述第一信道中接收到的绝对授权的标识为第 一 E-RNTI、主 E-RNTI或者主授权有效性设置为假, 并且所述绝对授权的 绝对授权值不是去激活命令, 则当所述绝对授权的绝对授权值不是零授权 命令时, 所述用户设备将服务授权设置为所述绝对授权值与最小配置服务 授权值中的最大值;或者, 当所述绝对授权的绝对授权值为零授权命令时, 所述用户设备将服务授权设置为零授权。
9、 根据权利要求 2-8任意一项所述的方法, 其特征在于, 所述用户设 备向无线网络控制器上报所述用户设备支持上行增强专用信道的能力包 括:
所述用户设备向所述无线网络控制器上报所述用户设备在上行增强 专用信道操作期间支持接收标识为第一 E-RNTI的绝对授权的能力。
10、 根据权利要求 1所述的方法, 其特征在于, 所述配置消息携带的 E-RNTI包括主 E-RNTI和辅 E-RNTI;
所述为所述用户设备所属的群组分配的 E-RNTI为所述辅 E-RNTI。
11、 根据权利要求 10所述的方法, 其特征在于, 所述根据所述用户 设备在所述第一信道中接收到的绝对授权激活或去激活混合自动重传请 求 HARQ进程包括:
如果所述用户设备在所述第一信道中接收到的绝对授权的标识为辅
E-RNTI, 并且所述绝对授权的绝对授权值为去激活命令, 则当所述绝对授 权的绝对授权范围为每 HARQ进程和已配置 2毫秒 TTI时, 所述用户设 备去激活当前 TTI对应的 HARQ进程号所对应的 HARQ进程; 或者, 当 所述绝对授权的绝对授权范围为所有 HARQ进程和已配置 2毫秒 TTI时, 所述用户设备去激活所有 HARQ进程。
12、 根据权利要求 10所述的方法, 其特征在于, 所述根据所述用户 设备在所述第一信道中接收到的绝对授权激活或去激活混合自动重传请 求 HARQ进程包括:
如果所述用户设备在所述第一信道中接收到的绝对授权的标识为辅 E-RNTI, 并且所述绝对授权的绝对授权值不是去激活命令, 则当所述绝对 授权的绝对授权范围为每 HARQ进程时, 所述用户设备激活当前 TTI对 应的 HARQ进程号所对应的 HARQ进程; 或者, 当所述绝对授权的绝对 授权范围为所有 HARQ进程时, 所述用户设备激活所有 HARQ进程。
13、 根据权利要求 10所述的方法, 其特征在于, 所述根据所述用户 设备在所述第一信道中接收到的绝对授权激活或去激活混合自动重传请 求 HARQ进程包括:
如果所述用户设备在所述第一信道中接收到的绝对授权的标识为辅 E-RNTI, 并且所述绝对授权的绝对授权值不是去激活命令, 则所述用户设 备激活当前 TTI对应的 HARQ进程号所对应的 HARQ进程 , 并去激活所 有 HARQ进程中除当前 TTI对应的 HARQ进程号所对应的 HARQ进程之 夕卜的 HARQ进程。
14、 根据权利要求 10所述的方法, 其特征在于, 还包括:
如果所述用户设备在所述第一信道中接收到的绝对授权的标识为辅 E-RNTI, 并且所述绝对授权的绝对授权值不是去激活命令, 则当所述绝对 授权值不是零授权命令时, 所述用户设备将服务授权设置为所述绝对授权 值与最小配置服务授权值中的最大值; 或者, 当所述绝对授权值是零授权 命令时, 所述用户设备将服务授权设置为零授权。
15、 根据权利要求 10所述的方法, 其特征在于, 还包括:
如果所述用户设备在所述第一信道中接收到的绝对授权的标识为辅 E-RNTI, 并且所述绝对授权的绝对授权值不是去激活命令, 则当所述绝对 授权的定时器处于未触发状态时, 所述用户设备启动所述定时器; 或者, 当所述绝对授权的定时器处于触发状态时, 所述用户设备重置所述定时 器。
16、 根据权利要求 1-15任意一项所述的方法, 其特征在于, 所述第一 信道包括增强专用信道绝对授权信道 E-AGCH、公共 E-AGCH或非服务小 区 E-AGCH。
17、 一种组调度授权的方法, 其特征在于, 包括:
基站接收到无线网络控制器发送的用户设备的上行增强专用信道配 置信息之后, 为所述用户设备配置增强专用信道无线网络临时标识 E-RNTI;
所述基站将为所述用户设备配置的 E-RNTI发送给无线网络控制器, 以便所述无线网络控制器将所述基站为所述用户设备配置的 E-RNTI发送 给所述用户设备; 所述基站为所述用户设备配置的 E-RNTI包括所述基站 为所述用户设备所属的群组分配的 E-RNTI;
所述基站通过第一信道向所述用户设备发送标识为配置的 E-RNTI的 绝对授权。
18、 根据权利要求 17 所述的方法, 其特征在于, 所述为所述用户设 备配置增强专用信道无线网络临时标识 E-RNTI包括:
所述基站为所述用户设备配置第一 E-RNTI和主 E-RNTI;
所述基站为所述用户设备所属的群组分配的 E-RNTI 为所述第一
E-RNTI。
19、 根据权利要求 18 所述的方法, 其特征在于, 所述基站通过第一 信道向所述用户设备发送标识为配置的 E-RNTI的绝对授权包括:
如果当前控制需求为单独控制, 则所述基站通过第一信道向所述用户 设备发送标识为所述主 E-RNTI的绝对授权; 或者,
如果当前控制需求为群组控制, 则所述基站通过第一信道向所述用户 设备发送标识为所述第一 E-RNTI的绝对授权。
20、 根据权利要求 18或 19所述的方法, 其特征在于, 所述基站通过 第一信道向所述用户设备发送标识为配置的 E-RNTI的绝对授权之后, 还 包括:
如果所述基站需要改变所述用户设备的第一 E-RNTI, 则所述基站向 所述无线网络控制器发送更新后的第一 E-RNTI, 并通知所述无线网络控 制器进行第一 E-RNTI的变更, 以便所述无线网络控制器将所述更新后的 第 ― E-RNTI发送给所述用户设备。
21、 根据权利要求 17 所述的方法, 其特征在于, 所述为所述用户设 备配置增强专用信道无线网络临时标识 E-RNTI包括:
所述基站为所述用户设备配置主 E-RNTI和辅 E-RNTI;
所述基站为所述用户设备所属的群组分配的 E-RNTI 为所述辅 E-RNTI。
22、 根据权利要求 21 所述的方法, 其特征在于, 所述基站通过第一 信道向所述用户设备发送标识为配置的 E-RNTI的绝对授权包括:
如果当前控制需求为单独控制, 则所述基站通过第一信道向所述用户 设备发送标识为所述主 E-RNTI的绝对授权; 或者, 如果当前控制需求为 群组控制, 则所述基站通过第一信道向所述用户设备发送标识为所述辅 E-RNTI的绝对授权。
23、 根据权利要求 21或 22所述的方法, 其特征在于, 所述基站通过 第一信道向所述用户设备发送标识为配置的 E-RNTI的绝对授权之后, 还 包括:
如果所述基站需要改变所述用户设备的辅 E-RNTI, 则所述基站向所 述无线网络控制器发送更新后的辅 E-RNTI, 并通知所述无线网络控制器 进行辅 E-RNTI 的变更, 以便所述无线网络控制器将所述更新后的辅 E-RNTI发送给所述用户设备。
24、 根据权利要求 17-23任意一项所述的方法, 其特征在于, 所述基 站接收到无线网络控制器发送的用户设备的上行增强专用信道配置信息 之后, 所述为所述用户设备配置增强专用信道无线网络临时标识 E-RNTI 之前, 还包括:
所述基站接收所述无线网络控制器发送的指示消息, 所述指示消息用 于指示所述基站进行无线链路建立的消息配置。
25、 根据权利要求 17-23任意一项所述的方法, 其特征在于, 所述为 所述用户设备配置增强专用信道无线网络临时标识 E-RNTI包括:
所述基站根据当前控制参考信息为所述用户设备配置 E-RNTI; 所述 当前控制参考信息包括: 所述用户设备的速率、 所述用户设备的数据块、 所述用户设备被分配的进程号、 所述用户设备对应的分组信息和当前小区 进程使用情况之一或组合。
26、 根据权利要求 17-25任意一项所述的方法, 其特征在于, 所述绝对授权包括所述用户设备的 HARQ进程的激活或去激活指示, 所述用户设备的 HARQ进程的激活指示为具体的授权值。
27、 一种组调度授权的方法, 其特征在于, 包括:
无线网络控制器接收用户设备上报的所述用户设备支持上行增强专 用信道的能力;
所述无线网络控制器将所述用户设备的上行增强专用信道配置信息 发送给基站;
所述无线网络控制器接收所述基站发送的所述基站为所述用户设备 配置的 E-RNTI;所述基站为所述用户设备配置的 E-RNTI包括所述基站为 所述用户设备所属的群组分配的 E-RNTI; 所述无线网络控制器将所述基站为所述用户设备配置的 E-RNTI发送 给所述用户设备, 以便所述用户设备釆用所述配置的 E-RNTI监听第一信 道, 并根据在所述第一信道中接收到的绝对授权激活或去激活混合自动重 传请求 HARQ进程。
28、 根据权利要求 27 所述的方法, 其特征在于, 所述基站为所述用 户设备配置的 E-RNTI包括第一 E-RNTI和主 E-RNTI;
所述基站为所述用户设备所属的群组分配的 E-RNTI 为所述第一 E-RNTI。
29、 根据权利要求 28 所述的方法, 其特征在于, 所述将所述基站为 所述用户设备配置的 E-RNTI发送给所述用户设备之后, 还包括:
所述无线网络控制器接收所述基站发送的更新后的第一 E-RNTI, 以 及接收所述基站发送的进行第一 E-RNTI的变更的通知;
所述无线网络控制器将所述更新后的第一 E-RNTI发送给所述用户设 备。
30、 根据权利要求 27 所述的方法, 其特征在于, 所述基站为所述用 户设备配置的 E-RNTI包括主 E-RNTI和辅 E-RNTI;
所述基站为所述用户设备所属的群组分配的 E-RNTI 为所述辅 E-RNTI。
31、 根据权利要求 30所述的方法, 其特征在于, 所述将所述基站为 所述用户设备配置的 E-RNTI发送给所述用户设备之后, 还包括:
所述无线网络控制器接收所述基站发送的更新后的辅 E-RNTI, 以及 接收所述基站发送的进行辅 E-RNTI的变更的通知;
所述无线网络控制器将所述更新后的辅 E-RNTI 发送给所述用户设 备。
32、 根据权利要求 27-31任意一项所述的方法, 其特征在于, 所述无 线网络控制器将所述用户设备的上行增强专用信道配置信息发送给基站 之后, 所述无线网络控制器接收所述基站发送的所述基站为所述用户设备 配置的 E-RNTI之前 , 还包括:
所述无线网络控制器向所述基站发送指示消息, 所述指示消息用于指 示所述基站进行无线链路建立的消息配置。
33、 一种用户设备, 其特征在于, 包括:
上报模块, 用于向无线网络控制器上报所述用户设备支持上行增强专 用信道的能力;
接收模块, 用于接收所述无线网络控制器发送的配置消息, 所述配置 消息携带增强专用信道无线网络临时标识 E-RNTI; 所述配置消息携带的 E-RNTI包括为所述用户设备所属的群组分配的 E-RNTI;
监听模块, 用于釆用所述接收模块接收的配置消息携带的 E-RNTI监 听第一信道;
激活 /去激活模块,用于根据所述监听模块在所述第一信道中接收到的 绝对授权激活或去激活混合自动重传请求 HARQ进程。
34、 根据权利要求 33 所述的用户设备, 其特征在于, 所述接收模块 接收的配置消息携带的 E-RNTI包括第 ― E-RNTI和主 E-RNTI; 所述为所 述用户设备所属的群组分配的 E-RNTI为所述第一 E-RNTI。
35、 根据权利要求 34所述的用户设备, 其特征在于, 还包括: 第一 确定模块;
所述第一确定模块,用于在所述激活 /去激活模块激活或去激活 HARQ 进程之前, 当所述监听模块在所述第一信道中接收到标识为第一 E-RNTI 或主 E-RNTI的绝对授权时 ,确定标识为第一 E-RNTI或主 E-RNTI的绝对 授权的类型为主授权。
36、 根据权利要求 34或 35所述的用户设备, 其特征在于,
所述激活 /去激活模块,具体用于当所述监听模块在所述第一信道中接 收到的绝对授权的标识为第一 E-RNTI, 并且所述绝对授权的绝对授权值 为去激活命令时,如果所述绝对授权的绝对授权范围为每 HARQ进程和已 配置 2毫秒传输时间间隔 TTI,则去激活当前 TTI对应的 HARQ进程号所 对应的 HARQ 进程; 或者, 如果所述绝对授权的绝对授权范围为所有 HARQ进程、已配置 2毫秒 TTI并且未配置辅 E-RNTI,则去激活所有 HARQ 进程; 或者,如果所述绝对授权的绝对授权范围为所有 HARQ进程和已配 置辅 E-RNTI, 则激活所有 HARQ进程, 将服务授权设置为储存第二授权 值, 并将主授权有效性设置为假。
37、 根据权利要求 34或 35所述的用户设备, 其特征在于, 所述激活 /去激活模块,具体用于当所述监听模块在所述第一信道中接 收到的绝对授权的标识为第一 E-RNTI, 并且所述绝对授权的绝对授权值 不是去激活命令时, 如果所述绝对授权的绝对授权范围为每 HARQ进程, 则激活当前 TTI对应的 HARQ进程号所对应的 HARQ进程; 或者 , 如果 所述绝对授权的绝对授权范围为所有 HARQ进程, 则激活所有 HARQ进 程。
38、 根据权利要求 34或 35所述的用户设备, 其特征在于,
所述激活 /去激活模块,具体用于当所述监听模块在所述第一信道中接 收到的绝对授权的标识为第一 E-RNTI, 并且所述绝对授权的绝对授权值 不是去激活命令时, 激活当前 ΤΉ对应的 HARQ进程号所对应的 HARQ 进程 , 并去激活所有 HARQ进程中除当前 TTI对应的 HARQ进程号所对 应的 HARQ进程之外的 HARQ进程。
39、 根据权利要求 34或 35所述的用户设备, 其特征在于, 还包括: 第一设置模块;
所述第一设置模块, 用于当所述监听模块在所述第一信道中接收到的 绝对授权的标识为第一 E-RNTI, 并且所述绝对授权的绝对授权值不是去 激活命令时, 将主授权有效性设置为真;
或者,
所述第一设置模块, 用于当所述监听模块在所述第一信道中接收到的 绝对授权的标识为第一 E-RNTI, 并且所述绝对授权的绝对授权值不是去 激活命令时, 如果所述绝对授权的定时器处于未触发状态, 则启动所述定 时器, 或者, 如果所述绝对授权的定时器处于触发状态, 则重置所述定时
所述第一设置模块, 用于当所述监听模块在所述第一信道中接收到的 绝对授权的标识为第一 E-RNTI、 主 E-RNTI或者主授权有效性设置为假, 并且所述绝对授权的绝对授权值不是去激活命令时, 如果所述绝对授权的 绝对授权值不是零授权命令, 则将服务授权设置为所述绝对授权值与最小 配置服务授权值中的最大值; 或者, 如果所述绝对授权的绝对授权值为零 授权命令, 则将服务授权设置为零授权。
40、 根据权利要求 34-39任意一项所述的用户设备, 其特征在于, 所述上报模块, 具体用于向所述无线网络控制器上报所述用户设备在 上行增强专用信道操作期间支持接收标识为第一 E-RNTI的绝对授权的能 力。
41、 根据权利要求 33 所述的用户设备, 其特征在于, 所述接收模块 接收的配置消息携带的 E-RNTI包括主 E-RNTI和辅 E-RNTI; 所述为所述 用户设备所属的群组分配的 E-RNTI为所述辅 E-RNTI。
42、 根据权利要求 41所述的用户设备, 其特征在于,
所述激活 /去激活模块,具体用于当所述监听模块在所述第一信道中接 收到的绝对授权的标识为辅 E-RNTI, 并且所述绝对授权的绝对授权值为 去激活命令时 ,如果所述绝对授权的绝对授权范围为每 HARQ进程和已配 置 2毫秒 ΤΉ, 则去激活当前 ΤΉ对应的 HARQ进程号所对应的 HARQ 进程; 或者,如果所述绝对授权的绝对授权范围为所有 HARQ进程和已配 置 2毫秒 TTI , 则去激活所有 HARQ进程。
43、 根据权利要求 41所述的用户设备, 其特征在于,
所述激活 /去激活模块,具体用于当所述监听模块在所述第一信道中接 收到的绝对授权的标识为辅 E-RNTI, 并且所述绝对授权的绝对授权值不 是去激活命令时,如果所述绝对授权的绝对授权范围为每 HARQ进程, 则 激活当前 TTI对应的 HARQ进程号所对应的 HARQ进程; 或者, 如果所 述绝对授权的绝对授权范围为所有 HARQ进程, 则激活所有 HARQ进程。
44、 根据权利要求 41所述的用户设备, 其特征在于,
所述激活 /去激活模块,具体用于当所述监听模块在所述第一信道中接 收到的绝对授权的标识为辅 E-RNTI, 并且所述绝对授权的绝对授权值不 是去激活命令时 , 激活当前 TTI对应的 HARQ进程号所对应的 HARQ进 程 , 并去激活所有 HARQ进程中除当前 TTI对应的 HARQ进程号所对应 的 HARQ进程之外的 HARQ进程。
45、 根据权利要求 41 所述的用户设备, 其特征在于, 还包括: 第二 设置模块;
所述第二设置模块, 用于当所述监听模块在所述第一信道中接收到的 绝对授权的标识为辅 E-RNTI, 并且所述绝对授权的绝对授权值不是去激 活命令时, 如果所述绝对授权值不是零授权命令, 则将服务授权设置为所 述绝对授权值与最小配置服务授权值中的最大值; 或者, 如果所述绝对授 权值是零授权命令, 则将服务授权设置为零授权;
或者,
所述第二设置模块, 用于当所述监听模块在所述第一信道中接收到的 绝对授权的标识为辅 E-RNTI, 并且所述绝对授权的绝对授权值不是去激 活命令时, 如果所述绝对授权的定时器处于未触发状态, 则启动所述定时 器; 或者, 如果所述绝对授权的定时器处于触发状态, 则重置所述定时器。
46、 一种基站, 其特征在于, 包括:
接收模块, 用于接收无线网络控制器发送的用户设备的上行增强专用 信道配置信息;
配置模块, 用于在所述接收模块接收到所述用户设备的上行增强专用 信道配置信息之后, 为所述用户设备配置增强专用信道无线网络临时标识
E-RNTI; 所述配置模块为所述用户设备配置的 E-RNTI包括所述配置模块 为所述用户设备所属的群组分配的 E-RNTI;
发送模块, 用于将所述配置模块为所述用户设备配置的 E-RNTI发送 给无线网络控制器, 以及通过第一信道向所述用户设备发送标识为配置的 E-RNTI的绝对授权。
47、 根据权利要求 46所述的基站, 其特征在于,
所述配置模块, 具体用于为所述用户设备配置第一 E-RNTI 和主
E-RNTI;
所述配置模块为所述用户设备所属的群组分配的 E-RNTI为所述第一 E-RNTI。
48、 根据权利要求 47 所述的基站, 其特征在于, 所述发送模块用于 通过第一信道向所述用户设备发送标识为配置的 E-RNTI 的绝对授权包 括:
所述发送模块, 具体用于在当前控制需求为单独控制时, 通过第一信 道向所述用户设备发送标识为所述主 E-RNTI的绝对授权; 或者, 在当前 控制需求为群组控制时, 通过第一信道向所述用户设备发送标识为所述第 一 E-RNTI的绝对授权。
49、 根据权利要求 47或 48所述的基站, 其特征在于,
所述发送模块, 还用于在向所述用户设备发送标识为配置的 E-RNTI 的绝对授权之后, 当所述基站需要改变所述用户设备的第一 E-RNTI时, 向所述无线网络控制器发送更新后的第一 E-RNTI, 并通知所述无线网络 控制器进行第一 E-RNTI的变更, 以便所述无线网络控制器将所述更新后 的第一 E-RNTI发送给所述用户设备。
50、 根据权利要求 46所述的基站, 其特征在于,
所述配置模块, 具体用于为所述用户设备配置主 E-RNTI 和辅 E-RNTI;
所述配置模块为所述用户设备所属的群组分配的 E-RNTI 为所述辅
E-RNTI。
51、 根据权利要求 50所述的基站, 其特征在于, 所述发送模块用于 通过第一信道向所述用户设备发送标识为配置的 E-RNTI 的绝对授权包 括:
所述发送模块, 具体用于在当前控制需求为单独控制时, 通过第一信 道向所述用户设备发送标识为所述主 E-RNTI的绝对授权; 或者, 在当前 控制需求为群组控制时, 通过第一信道向所述用户设备发送标识为所述辅 E-RNTI的绝对授权。
52、 根据权利要求 50或 51所述的基站, 其特征在于,
所述发送模块, 还用于在向所述用户设备发送标识为配置的 E-RNTI 的绝对授权之后, 当所述基站需要改变所述用户设备的辅 E-RNTI时, 向 所述无线网络控制器发送更新后的辅 E-RNTI, 并通知所述无线网络控制 器进行辅 E-RNTI 的变更, 以便所述无线网络控制器将所述更新后的辅 E-RNTI发送给所述用户设备。
53、 根据权利要求 46-52任意一项所述的基站, 其特征在于, 所述接收模块, 还用于在接收到无线网络控制器发送的用户设备的上 行增强专用信道配置信息之后, 所述配置模块为所述用户设备配置增强专 用信道无线网络临时标识 E-RNTI之前, 接收所述无线网络控制器发送的 指示消息, 所述指示消息用于指示所述基站进行无线链路建立的消息配 置。
54、 根据权利要求 46-52任意一项所述的基站, 其特征在于, 所述配置模块, 具体用于根据当前控制参考信息为所述用户设备配置 E-RNTI; 所述当前控制参考信息包括: 所述用户设备的速率、 所述用户设 备的数据块、 所述用户设备被分配的进程号、 所述用户设备对应的分组信 息和当前小区进程使用情况之一或组合。
55、 一种无线网络控制器, 其特征在于, 包括:
接收模块, 用于接收用户设备上报的所述用户设备支持上行增强专用 信道的能力; 以及在发送模块将所述用户设备的上行增强专用信道配置信 息发送给基站之后, 接收所述基站发送的所述基站为所述用户设备配置的 E-RNTI; 所述基站为所述用户设备配置的 E-RNTI包括所述基站为所述用 户设备所属的群组分配的 E-RNTI;
所述发送模块, 用于将所述用户设备的上行增强专用信道配置信息发 送给基站; 以及在所述接收模块接收所述基站发送的所述基站为所述用户 设备配置的 E-RNTI之后, 将所述基站为所述用户设备配置的 E-RNTI发 送给所述用户设备, 以便所述用户设备釆用所述配置的 E-RNTI监听第一 信道, 并根据在所述第一信道中接收到的绝对授权激活或去激活混合自动 重传请求 HARQ进程。
56、 根据权利要求 55 所述的无线网络控制器, 其特征在于, 所述接 收模块接收的所述基站为所述用户设备配置的 E-RNTI 包括第一 E-RNTI 和主 E-RNTI;
其中, 所述基站为所述用户设备所属的群组分配的 E-RNTI为所述第 一 E-RNTI。
57、 根据权利要求 56所述的无线网络控制器, 其特征在于, 所述接收模块, 还用于在所述发送模块将所述基站为所述用户设备配 置的 E-RNTI发送给所述用户设备之后, 接收所述基站发送的更新后的第 ― E-RNTI, 以及接收所述基站发送的进行第一 E-RNTI的变更的通知; 所述发送模块, 还用于将所述接收模块接收的更新后的第一 E-RNTI 发送给所述用户设备。
58、 根据权利要求 55 所述的无线网络控制器, 其特征在于, 所述接 收模块接收的所述基站为所述用户设备配置的 E-RNTI包括主 E-RNTI和 辅 E-RNTI; 其中, 所述基站为所述用户设备所属的群组分配的 E-RNTI 为所述辅 E-RNTI。
59、 根据权利要求 58所述的无线网络控制器, 其特征在于, 所述接收模块, 还用于在所述发送模块将所述基站为所述用户设备配 置的 E-RNTI发送给所述用户设备之后, 接收所述基站发送的更新后的辅 E-RNTI, 以及接收所述基站发送的进行辅 E-RNTI的变更的通知;
所述发送模块, 还用于将所述接收模块接收的更新后的辅 E-RNTI发 送给所述用户设备。
60、 根据权利要求 55-59任意一项所述的无线网络控制器, 其特征在 于,
所述发送模块, 还用于在将所述用户设备的上行增强专用信道配置信 息发送给基站之后, 所述接收模块接收所述基站发送的所述基站为所述用 户设备配置的 E-RNTI之前, 向所述基站发送指示消息, 所述指示消息用 于指示所述基站进行无线链路建立的消息配置。
61、 一种用户设备, 其特征在于, 包括:
发送器, 用于向无线网络控制器上报所述用户设备支持上行增强专用 信道的能力;
接收器, 用于接收所述无线网络控制器发送的配置消息, 所述配置消 息携带增强专用信道无线网络临时标识 E-RNTI; 所述配置消息携带的 E-RNTI包括为所述用户设备所属的群组分配的 E-RNTI;
处理器, 用于釆用所述接收器接收的配置消息携带的 E-RNTI监听第 一信道, 以及根据在所述第一信道中接收到的绝对授权激活或去激活混合 自动重传请求 HARQ进程。
62、 根据权利要求 61 所述的用户设备, 其特征在于, 所述接收器接 收的配置消息携带的 E-RNTI包括第 ― E-RNTI和主 E-RNTI; 所述为所述 用户设备所属的群组分配的 E-RNTI为所述第一 E-RNTI。
63、 根据权利要求 62所述的用户设备, 其特征在于,
所述处理器,还用于在激活或去激活 HARQ进程之前, 当在所述第一 信道中接收到标识为第一 E-RNTI或主 E-RNTI的绝对授权时, 确定标识 为第一 E-RNTI或主 E-RNTI的绝对授权的类型为主授权。
64、 根据权利要求 62或 63所述的用户设备, 其特征在于, 所述处理 器用于根据在所述第一信道中接收到的绝对授权激活或去激活混合自动 重传请求 HARQ进程包括:
所述处理器, 具体用于当在所述第一信道中接收到的绝对授权的标识 为第一 E-RNTI, 并且所述绝对授权的绝对授权值为去激活命令时, 如果 所述绝对授权的绝对授权范围为每 HARQ进程和已配置 2毫秒传输时间间 隔 TTI, 则去激活当前 TTI对应的 HARQ进程号所对应的 HARQ进程; 或者, 如果所述绝对授权的绝对授权范围为所有 HARQ 进程、 已配置 2 毫秒 TTI并且未配置辅 E-RNTI, 则去激活所有 HARQ进程; 或者, 如果 所述绝对授权的绝对授权范围为所有 HARQ进程和已配置辅 E-RNTI , 则 激活所有 HARQ进程,将服务授权设置为储存第二授权值, 并将主授权有 效性设置为假。
65、 根据权利要求 62或 63所述的用户设备, 其特征在于, 所述处理 器用于根据在所述第一信道中接收到的绝对授权激活或去激活混合自动 重传请求 HARQ进程包括:
所述处理器, 具体用于当在所述第一信道中接收到的绝对授权的标识 为第一 E-RNTI, 并且所述绝对授权的绝对授权值不是去激活命令时, 如 果所述绝对授权的绝对授权范围为每 HARQ进程, 则激活当前 TTI对应 的 HARQ进程号所对应的 HARQ进程; 或者, 如果所述绝对授权的绝对 授权范围为所有 HARQ进程, 则激活所有 HARQ进程。
66、 根据权利要求 62或 63所述的用户设备, 其特征在于, 所述处理 器用于根据在所述第一信道中接收到的绝对授权激活或去激活混合自动 重传请求 HARQ进程包括:
所述处理器, 具体用于当在所述第一信道中接收到的绝对授权的标识 为第一 E-RNTI, 并且所述绝对授权的绝对授权值不是去激活命令时, 激 活当前 TTI对应的 HARQ进程号所对应的 HARQ 进程, 并去激活所有 HARQ进程中除当前 TTI对应的 HARQ进程号所对应的 HARQ进程之外 的 HARQ进程。
67、 根据权利要求 62或 63所述的用户设备, 其特征在于,
所述处理器, 还用于当在所述第一信道中接收到的绝对授权的标识为 第一 E-RNTI, 并且所述绝对授权的绝对授权值不是去激活命令时, 将主 授权有效性设置为真;
或者,
所述处理器, 还用于当在所述第一信道中接收到的绝对授权的标识为 第一 E-RNTI, 并且所述绝对授权的绝对授权值不是去激活命令时, 如果 所述绝对授权的定时器处于未触发状态, 则启动所述定时器, 或者, 如果 所述绝对授权的定时器处于触发状态, 则重置所述定时器。
68、 根据权利要求 62或 63所述的用户设备, 其特征在于, 所述处理器, 还用于当在所述第一信道中接收到的绝对授权的标识为 第一 E-RNTI、主 E-RNTI或者主授权有效性设置为假, 并且所述绝对授权 的绝对授权值不是去激活命令时, 如果所述绝对授权的绝对授权值不是零 授权命令, 则将服务授权设置为所述绝对授权值与最小配置服务授权值中 的最大值; 或者, 如果所述绝对授权的绝对授权值为零授权命令, 则将服 务授权设置为零授权。
69、 根据权利要求 62-68任意一项所述的用户设备, 其特征在于, 所述发送器, 具体用于向所述无线网络控制器上报所述用户设备在上 行增强专用信道操作期间支持接收标识为第一 E-RNTI 的绝对授权的能 力。
70、 根据权利要求 61 所述的用户设备, 其特征在于, 所述接收器接 收的配置消息携带的 E-RNTI包括主 E-RNTI和辅 E-RNTI; 所述为所述用 户设备所属的群组分配的 E-RNTI为所述辅 E-RNTI。
71、 根据权利要求 70所述的用户设备, 其特征在于, 所述处理器用 于根据在所述第一信道中接收到的绝对授权激活或去激活混合自动重传 请求 HARQ进程包括:
所述处理器, 具体用于当在所述第一信道中接收到的绝对授权的标识 为辅 E-RNTI, 并且所述绝对授权的绝对授权值为去激活命令时, 如果所 述绝对授权的绝对授权范围为每 HARQ进程和已配置 2毫秒 TTI,则去激 活当前 TTI对应的 HARQ进程号所对应的 HARQ进程; 或者, 如果所述 绝对授权的绝对授权范围为所有 HARQ进程和已配置 2毫秒 TTI,则去激 活所有 HARQ进程。
72、 根据权利要求 70所述的用户设备, 其特征在于, 所述处理器用 于根据在所述第一信道中接收到的绝对授权激活或去激活混合自动重传 请求 HARQ进程包括:
所述处理器, 具体用于当在所述第一信道中接收到的绝对授权的标识 为辅 E-RNTI, 并且所述绝对授权的绝对授权值不是去激活命令时, 如果 所述绝对授权的绝对授权范围为每 HARQ进程, 则激活当前 TTI对应的 HARQ进程号所对应的 HARQ进程; 或者, 如果所述绝对授权的绝对授 权范围为所有 HARQ进程, 则激活所有 HARQ进程。
73、 根据权利要求 70所述的用户设备, 其特征在于, 所述处理器用 于根据在所述第一信道中接收到的绝对授权激活或去激活混合自动重传 请求 HARQ进程包括:
所述处理器, 具体用于当在所述第一信道中接收到的绝对授权的标识 为辅 E-RNTI, 并且所述绝对授权的绝对授权值不是去激活命令时, 激活 当前 TTI对应的 HARQ进程号所对应的 HARQ进程,并去激活所有 HARQ 进程。
74、 根据权利要求 70所述的用户设备, 其特征在于,
所述处理器, 还用于当在所述第一信道中接收到的绝对授权的标识为 辅 E-RNTI, 并且所述绝对授权的绝对授权值不是去激活命令时, 如果所 述绝对授权值不是零授权命令, 则将服务授权设置为所述绝对授权值与最 小配置服务授权值中的最大值;或者,如果所述绝对授权值是零授权命令, 则将服务授权设置为零授权。
75、 根据权利要求 70所述的用户设备, 其特征在于,
所述处理器, 还用于当在所述第一信道中接收到的绝对授权的标识为 辅 E-RNTI, 并且所述绝对授权的绝对授权值不是去激活命令时, 如果所 述绝对授权的定时器处于未触发状态, 则启动所述定时器; 或者, 如果所 述绝对授权的定时器处于触发状态时, 则重置所述定时器。
76、 一种基站, 其特征在于, 包括:
接收器, 用于接收无线网络控制器发送的用户设备的上行增强专用信 道配置信息; 处理器, 用于在所述接收器接收到所述用户设备的上行增强专用信道 配置信息之后, 为所述用户设备配置增强专用信道无线网络临时标识
E-RNTI; 所述处理器为所述用户设备配置的 E-RNTI包括所述处理器为所 述用户设备所属的群组分配的 E-RNTI;
发送器, 用于将所述处理器为所述用户设备配置的 E-RNTI发送给无 线网络控制器, 以及通过第一信道向所述用户设备发送标识为配置的 E-RNTI的绝对授权。
77、 根据权利要求 76所述的基站, 其特征在于,
所述处理器, 具体用于为所述用户设备配置第一 E-RNTI 和主 E-RNTI;
所述处理器为所述用户设备所属的群组分配的 E-RNTI 为所述第一 E-RNTI。
78、 根据权利要求 77 所述的基站, 其特征在于, 所述发送器用于通 过第一信道向所述用户设备发送标识为配置的 E-RNTI的绝对授权包括: 所述发送器, 具体用于在当前控制需求为单独控制时, 通过第一信道 向所述用户设备发送标识为所述主 E-RNTI的绝对授权; 或者, 在当前控 制需求为群组控制时, 通过第一信道向所述用户设备发送标识为所述第 ― E-RNTI的绝对授权。
79、 根据权利要求 77或 78所述的基站, 其特征在于,
所述发送器, 还用于在向所述用户设备发送标识为配置的 E-RNTI的 绝对授权之后, 当所述基站需要改变所述用户设备的第一 E-RNTI时, 向 所述无线网络控制器发送更新后的第一 E-RNTI, 并通知所述无线网络控 制器进行第一 E-RNTI的变更, 以便所述无线网络控制器将所述更新后的 第 ― E-RNTI发送给所述用户设备。
80、 根据权利要求 76所述的基站, 其特征在于,
所述处理器, 具体用于为所述用户设备配置主 E-RNTI和辅 E-RNTI; 所述处理器为所述用户设备所属的群组分配的 E-RNTI为所述辅 E-RNTI。
81、 根据权利要求 80所述的基站, 其特征在于, 所述发送器用于通 过第一信道向所述用户设备发送标识为配置的 E-RNTI的绝对授权包括: 所述发送器, 具体用于在当前控制需求为单独控制时, 通过第一信道 向所述用户设备发送标识为所述主 E-RNTI的绝对授权; 或者, 在当前控 制需求为群组控制时, 通过第一信道向所述用户设备发送标识为所述辅 E-RNTI的绝对授权。
82、 根据权利要求 80或 81所述的基站, 其特征在于,
所述发送器, 还用于在向所述用户设备发送标识为配置的 E-RNTI的 绝对授权之后, 当所述基站需要改变所述用户设备的辅 E-RNTI时, 向所 述无线网络控制器发送更新后的辅 E-RNTI, 并通知所述无线网络控制器 进行辅 E-RNTI 的变更, 以便所述无线网络控制器将所述更新后的辅 E-RNTI发送给所述用户设备。
83、 根据权利要求 76-82任意一项所述的基站, 其特征在于, 所述接收器, 还用于在接收到无线网络控制器发送的用户设备的上行 增强专用信道配置信息之后, 所述处理器为所述用户设备配置增强专用信 道无线网络临时标识 E-RNTI之前, 接收所述无线网络控制器发送的指示 消息, 所述指示消息用于指示所述基站进行无线链路建立的消息配置。
84、 根据权利要求 76-82任意一项所述的基站, 其特征在于, 所述处理器, 具体用于根据当前控制参考信息为所述用户设备配置 E-RNTI; 所述当前控制参考信息包括: 所述用户设备的速率、 所述用户设 备的数据块、 所述用户设备被分配的进程号、 所述用户设备对应的分组信 息和当前小区进程使用情况之一或组合。
85、 一种无线网络控制器, 其特征在于, 包括:
接收器, 用于接收用户设备上报的所述用户设备支持上行增强专用信 道的能力; 以及在发送器将所述用户设备的上行增强专用信道配置信息发 送给基站之后, 接收所述基站发送的所述基站为所述用户设备配置的 E-RNTI; 所述基站为所述用户设备配置的 E-RNTI包括所述基站为所述用 户设备所属的群组分配的 E-RNTI;
所述发送器, 用于将所述用户设备的上行增强专用信道配置信息发送 给基站; 以及在所述接收器接收所述基站发送的所述基站为所述用户设备 配置的 E-RNTI之后, 将所述基站为所述用户设备配置的 E-RNTI发送给 所述用户设备,以便所述用户设备釆用所述配置的 E-RNTI监听第一信道, 并根据在所述第一信道中接收到的绝对授权激活或去激活混合自动重传 请求 HARQ进程。
86、 根据权利要求 85 所述的无线网络控制器, 其特征在于, 所述接 收器接收的所述基站为所述用户设备配置的 E-RNTI包括第一 E-RNTI和 主 E-RNTI;
其中, 所述基站为所述用户设备所属的群组分配的 E-RNTI为所述第 一 E-RNTI。
87、 根据权利要求 86所述的无线网络控制器, 其特征在于, 所述接收器, 还用于在所述发送器将所述基站为所述用户设备配置的 E-RNTI 发送给所述用户设备之后, 接收所述基站发送的更新后的第一 E-RNTI, 以及接收所述基站发送的进行第一 E-RNTI的变更的通知; 所述发送器, 还用于将所述接收器接收的更新后的第一 E-RNTI发送 给所述用户设备。
88、 根据权利要求 85 所述的无线网络控制器, 其特征在于, 所述接 收器接收的所述基站为所述用户设备配置的 E-RNTI包括主 E-RNTI和辅 E-RNTI; 其中, 所述基站为所述用户设备所属的群组分配的 E-RNTI为所 述辅 E-RNTL
89、 根据权利要求 88所述的无线网络控制器, 其特征在于, 所述接收器, 还用于在所述发送器将所述基站为所述用户设备配置的 E-RNTI 发送给所述用户设备之后, 接收所述基站发送的更新后的辅 E-RNTI, 以及接收所述基站发送的进行辅 E-RNTI的变更的通知;
所述发送器, 还用于将所述接收器接收的更新后的辅 E-RNTI发送给 所述用户设备。
90、 根据权利要求 85-89任意一项所述的无线网络控制器, 其特征在 于,
所述发送器, 还用于在将所述用户设备的上行增强专用信道配置信息 发送给基站之后, 所述接收器接收所述基站发送的所述基站为所述用户设 备配置的 E-RNTI之前, 向所述基站发送指示消息, 所述指示消息用于指 示所述基站进行无线链路建立的消息配置。
PCT/CN2012/084894 2012-11-20 2012-11-20 组调度授权的方法、用户设备和无线网络控制器 WO2014078988A1 (zh)

Priority Applications (4)

Application Number Priority Date Filing Date Title
PCT/CN2012/084894 WO2014078988A1 (zh) 2012-11-20 2012-11-20 组调度授权的方法、用户设备和无线网络控制器
EP12888970.6A EP2914045B1 (en) 2012-11-20 2012-11-20 Group scheduling method and corresponding user equipment
CN201280002400.5A CN104025688A (zh) 2012-11-20 2012-11-20 组调度授权的方法、用户设备和无线网络控制器
US14/717,263 US9769845B2 (en) 2012-11-20 2015-05-20 Method for group scheduling grant, user equipment and radio network controller

Applications Claiming Priority (1)

Application Number Priority Date Filing Date Title
PCT/CN2012/084894 WO2014078988A1 (zh) 2012-11-20 2012-11-20 组调度授权的方法、用户设备和无线网络控制器

Related Child Applications (1)

Application Number Title Priority Date Filing Date
US14/717,263 Continuation US9769845B2 (en) 2012-11-20 2015-05-20 Method for group scheduling grant, user equipment and radio network controller

Publications (1)

Publication Number Publication Date
WO2014078988A1 true WO2014078988A1 (zh) 2014-05-30

Family

ID=50775375

Family Applications (1)

Application Number Title Priority Date Filing Date
PCT/CN2012/084894 WO2014078988A1 (zh) 2012-11-20 2012-11-20 组调度授权的方法、用户设备和无线网络控制器

Country Status (4)

Country Link
US (1) US9769845B2 (zh)
EP (1) EP2914045B1 (zh)
CN (1) CN104025688A (zh)
WO (1) WO2014078988A1 (zh)

Cited By (1)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
WO2020192430A1 (zh) * 2019-03-28 2020-10-01 华为技术有限公司 一种关闭harq进程的方法、接收设备以及发送设备

Families Citing this family (5)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
WO2016165123A1 (en) * 2015-04-17 2016-10-20 Mediatek Singapore Pte. Ltd. Enhancement for harq with channel repetitions
US10455611B2 (en) * 2015-09-16 2019-10-22 Lg Electronics Inc. Method for transceiving data in wireless communication system and apparatus for same
US10218402B2 (en) * 2017-05-09 2019-02-26 Qualcomm Incorporated Multi-subscriber identity module (SIM) call setup
AU2018445805B2 (en) * 2018-10-15 2023-01-12 Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. Terminal configuration method and apparatus
CN115243249B (zh) * 2019-09-20 2024-01-23 北京小米移动软件有限公司 通信方法、装置及存储介质

Citations (3)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
CN1917447A (zh) * 2006-02-08 2007-02-21 华为技术有限公司 一种高速上行分组接入系统中服务授权的配置方法
US20070223405A1 (en) * 2006-03-23 2007-09-27 Innovative Sonic Limited Method and apparatus for activating hybrid automatic repeat request process in a wireless communications system
WO2008040710A1 (en) * 2006-10-02 2008-04-10 Nokia Siemens Networks Gmbh & Co. Kg Method for the transmission of ip frames

Family Cites Families (15)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
US7408895B2 (en) * 2005-04-20 2008-08-05 Interdigital Technology Corporation Method and apparatus for scheduling transmissions via an enhanced dedicated channel
US8073450B2 (en) * 2006-03-20 2011-12-06 Innovative Sonic Limited Method and apparatus for de-activating hybrid automatic repeat request process in a wireless communications system
JP5054108B2 (ja) * 2006-08-21 2012-10-24 インターデイジタル テクノロジー コーポレーション アップリンクにおいてharqプロセスを動的に割り当てるための方法および装置
CN100574276C (zh) * 2006-08-22 2009-12-23 中兴通讯股份有限公司 时分同步码分多址系统增强上行链路随机接入的控制方法
US20080070583A1 (en) * 2006-09-14 2008-03-20 Innovative Sonic Limited Method and apparatus for setting serving grant in a wireless communications system
US8737241B2 (en) * 2007-10-08 2014-05-27 Telefonaktiebolaget L M Ericsson (Publ) Fast access to a dedicated uplink (E-DCH) resource by using a previously used configuration
KR20110095928A (ko) * 2008-02-01 2011-08-25 인터디지탈 패튼 홀딩스, 인크 서빙 고속 다운링크 공유 채널 셀 변경을 위한 방법 및 장치
JP4420258B2 (ja) * 2008-03-19 2010-02-24 日本電気株式会社 通信システム、移動局、基地局、応答決定方法、リソースコンフィグレーション決定方法及びプログラム
US8295779B2 (en) * 2008-10-31 2012-10-23 Interdigital Patent Holdings, Inc. Method and apparatus for wireless transmissions using multiple uplink carriers
EP2374316B1 (en) * 2008-10-31 2013-11-20 InterDigital Patent Holdings, Inc. Providing control information for multi-carrier uplink transmission
EP3664534A1 (en) * 2008-11-25 2020-06-10 InterDigital Patent Holdings, Inc. Method and apparatus for utilizing a plurality of uplink carriers and a plurality of downlink carriers
US8751892B2 (en) * 2011-08-09 2014-06-10 Intel Mobile Communications GmbH Communication terminals and communication devices
US8989117B2 (en) * 2011-08-16 2015-03-24 Telefonaktiebolaget L M Ericsson (Publ) Enhanced dedicated-channel signaling in a CELL—FACH state
US9055452B2 (en) * 2011-09-30 2015-06-09 Optis Wireless Technology, Llc Network node, user equipment and methods therein
US9433015B2 (en) * 2012-06-15 2016-08-30 Telefonaktiebolaget Lm Ericsson (Publ) Mitigating ghost signalling effects in radio systems

Patent Citations (3)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
CN1917447A (zh) * 2006-02-08 2007-02-21 华为技术有限公司 一种高速上行分组接入系统中服务授权的配置方法
US20070223405A1 (en) * 2006-03-23 2007-09-27 Innovative Sonic Limited Method and apparatus for activating hybrid automatic repeat request process in a wireless communications system
WO2008040710A1 (en) * 2006-10-02 2008-04-10 Nokia Siemens Networks Gmbh & Co. Kg Method for the transmission of ip frames

Non-Patent Citations (1)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Title
See also references of EP2914045A4 *

Cited By (1)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
WO2020192430A1 (zh) * 2019-03-28 2020-10-01 华为技术有限公司 一种关闭harq进程的方法、接收设备以及发送设备

Also Published As

Publication number Publication date
CN104025688A (zh) 2014-09-03
EP2914045A1 (en) 2015-09-02
US9769845B2 (en) 2017-09-19
EP2914045B1 (en) 2017-03-08
EP2914045A4 (en) 2015-09-30
US20150282209A1 (en) 2015-10-01

Similar Documents

Publication Publication Date Title
JP6618215B2 (ja) D2d通信の制御プレーンのためのシステムおよび方法
JP2020053986A (ja) 無線通信システムにおいて非競合ベースのチャネルを提供するため、および利用するための方法および装置
KR101152045B1 (ko) Hspa 시스템에서 강화된 rach를 이용한 wtru 상태 천이를 수행하기 위한 방법 및 장치
KR101266625B1 (ko) 요소 반송파를 모니터링하고 처리하는 방법 및 장치
CN102396280B (zh) 一种随机接入方法、演进基站及终端设备
EP3335521B1 (en) Reducing collisions between communication and discovery resources
WO2017012467A1 (zh) 一种资源分配的方法和设备
EP3873135B1 (en) System for implementing multiple radio access networks (rans) convergence and method thereof
US9769845B2 (en) Method for group scheduling grant, user equipment and radio network controller
JP5302335B2 (ja) 上りリソースを解放するようユーザ装置を制御する方法、装置、及びシステム
WO2012163023A1 (zh) 分配多载波资源的方法、基站、和终端
WO2012136101A1 (zh) 一种混合自动重传的处理方法、系统及装置
WO2010071547A1 (en) Hsupa carrier activation notification
WO2013064124A1 (zh) 传输时间间隔的确定方法、基站和无线网络控制器
WO2013020447A1 (zh) 预编码控制指示反馈信道配置方法和装置
EP3328144B1 (en) User equipment, network equipment, and data transmission method
WO2012174889A1 (zh) 联合传输中数据传输的方法、网元侧及用户设备
EP2661940A1 (en) A method of releasing resources (e-rnti) in a communications network
WO2021155547A1 (zh) 数据接收方法、装置、设备及存储介质
WO2014082215A1 (zh) Fdd系统中多载波配置、用户设备接入方法及相应装置
JP2013507802A (ja) 共通制御チャンネルのharq情報の取得方法及び装置
WO2010022556A1 (zh) 一种下行信号的分扇区处理方法及基站
WO2015190986A1 (en) Methods and arrangements for switching of states
WO2013007182A1 (zh) 多载波配置方法及装置
WO2015018364A1 (zh) 调度方法及装置

Legal Events

Date Code Title Description
121 Ep: the epo has been informed by wipo that ep was designated in this application

Ref document number: 12888970

Country of ref document: EP

Kind code of ref document: A1

NENP Non-entry into the national phase

Ref country code: DE

REEP Request for entry into the european phase

Ref document number: 2012888970

Country of ref document: EP

WWE Wipo information: entry into national phase

Ref document number: 2012888970

Country of ref document: EP